Xuv700 User Manual
Xuv700 User Manual
MAHINDRA & MAHINDRA LTD. GATEWAY BUILDING, APOLLO BUNDER, MUMBAI - 400 039 www.mahindra.com
FOREWORD
Your vehicle represents Robust Quality, Ruggedness, Safety, Precision Workmanship and Distinctive Styling , which are our
traditional values.
This documents contains important information on vehicle operation, that will help you make full use of the technical features
available. To exercise better control on road, we suggest you to please take time to read, understand and familiarise with vehicle
and its features. Following the instructions and recommendations in this manual will help assure safe and enjoyable operation of
your vehicle.
When it comes to service, note that your Mahindra Authorised Dealer knows your vehicle best, has company trained Technical
Experts, Mahindra Genuine Parts and very much cares about your satisfaction.
We strongly urge that you read the information provided in pages referred hereunder which will help in road safety and prevent
inconvenience
The vehicle's software and security measures are subject to ongoing development. Similar to computers and mobile device operating
systems, the software and security features of the car might also receive irregular updates.
Table of Contents
1 GENERAL AND SAFETY PRECAUTION ...........................1-1 Child Restraint System (CRS) ................................2-26
Servicing and Summary Data..................................1-1 Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) .............2-34
Safety Symbols ................................................................1-1 3 INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FEATURES.................................3-1
General Safety Information and Instrument Cluster Overview .................................3-1
Instructions .......................................................................1-2 Drive Mode (If equipped)...........................................3-6
To Users of a Mahindra Vehicle .............................1-2 Instrument Cluster Control Switches..................3-7
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) ....................1-7 Instrument Cluster screen flow .............................3-8
Engine Number...............................................................1-7 Drive Info............................................................................3-9
Front Overview................................................................1-8 Fuel Info ...........................................................................3-12
Rear Overview .................................................................1-9 Digital Speedo Meter (if equipped) ...................3-13
Instrument Panel/Door Trim Overview ..........1-10 Vehicle Info.....................................................................3-14
Roof Overview .............................................................1-11 Navigation (If equipped)..........................................3-15
Alexa Reference Guide.............................................1-12 Driver Assistance (ADAS) (If equipped) ...........3-16
ADRENOX Connect.....................................................1-13 Audio Info (If equipped) ..........................................3-16
2 SEATS AND SAFETY .................................................................2-1 Display Layout ..............................................................3-17
Seats......................................................................................2-1 Cluster Setting (if equipped) .................................3-18
Head Restraint..............................................................2-16 Alert History...................................................................3-25
Seat Belt ...........................................................................2-17 General Alerts ...............................................................3-25
Table of Contents
Steering Controls - Audio (if equipped) .............7-2 Driver Side Switch Bank ..........................................8-14
Cruise Control (if equipped).....................................7-4 Power Outlet .................................................................8-15
Advanced Driver Assistance System (If Wireless Mobile Charging (If equipped) .........8-17
equipped)...........................................................................7-7 Intelli Command Center Switch (ICC) ...............8-18
Adaptive Cruise Control (Only for Automatic Lamps................................................................................8-21
Transmission variant)..................................................7-9 Hazard Warning Lamp .............................................8-29
Collision Mitigation System ...................................7-30 Follow-Me Home (FMH) with Rain Light
High Beam Assist ........................................................7-48 Sensor (RLS) ...................................................................8-30
Traffic Sign Recognition...........................................7-51 Follow-Me Home Lamp (FMH) Non RLS (if
Lane Keep Assist System ........................................7-53 equipped)........................................................................8-31
Smart Pilot Assist System .......................................7-60 Lead Me to Vehicle Lamp(LMV) (if
8 CONVENIENCE SYSTEMS 1 .................................................8-1 equipped)........................................................................8-32
Control Switches.............................................................8-1 Remote Engine Start (If equipped) ....................8-32
Mirrors .................................................................................8-4 Windshield Wipers .....................................................8-33
Storage Compartments..............................................8-6 9 CONVENIENCE SYSTEMS II .................................................9-1
Microphone(as applicable) ....................................8-12 Skyroof ...............................................................................9-1
Sun Visor..........................................................................8-12 Power Window and Skyroof Smart Close and
Center Fascia Switch ................................................8-13 Open ..................................................................................9-10
Table of Contents
1.1 Servicing and Summary Data DANGER indicates an imminently hazardous situation
which, if not avoided, will result in death or serious injury.
We suggest that you record the vehicle servicing data in the
Warranty and Service Information Guide for future
references WARNING indicates a potentially hazardous situation which,
if not avoided, could result in death or serious injury.
We recommend you always use Mahindra Genuine Parts
when performing repairs on the vehicle.
For all issues concerning the vehicle and for any need of CAUTION indicates a potentially hazardous situation which,
Genuine spare parts, contact the Mahindra Authorised if not avoided, may result in minor or moderate injury and/
Dealer or property damage.
To emphasis the information and procedures regarding If you see this symbol, it indicates “no,” “ do
safety, use, maintenance, etc., the following symbols are not,” “do not do this,” or “never”.
used throughout the manual:
1.3 General Safety Information and Instructions plates or remove them. It is illegal to remove or alter
the numbers in the VIN plate.
1. First-aid kit is placed in the glove box of the vehicle.
Ensure it is not taken out of the vehicle at any point of 6. Do not attempt sharp turns, abrupt maneuvers, or
other unsafe driving actions that can cause loss of
time.
vehicle control. When the vehicle is fully loaded, drive
2. Please note that throughout this manual, reference is at a slow speed, especially when turning. Note that the
made that “an accident” could occur. An accident center of gravity of the vehicle changes when the
could cause you or a bystander to sustain personal vehicle is fully loaded, and also if luggage is mounted
injury, or result in property damage. on the roof carrier.
3. Inspect the seat belt system periodically, checking for
cuts, frays or wear in the seat belt webbing, or loose 1.4 To Users of a Mahindra Vehicle
buckles, retractors, anchors or other loose parts.
Damaged parts must be replaced immediately. When first driving the vehicle after long periods of non-
usage, you may experience a temporary drive disturbance.
4. The lifespan of Mahindra products depends on many This is a characteristic of the tyres and should be no reason
factors. Improper use, abuse or harsh use in general for concern. The condition should correct itself within 5-15
may compromise the integrity of the vehicle and kilometers. of driving. If the disturbance persists, have the
significantly reduce its lifespan. The vehicle is also vehicle checked by an Mahindra Authorised Dealer.
subject to wear over a period of time. Please have
your vehicle regularly inspected by a Mahindra Driving and Drugs/Medication
Authorised Dealer or a qualified Technician . If the
inspection reveals any damage or excessive wear, Your driving ability can be seriously impaired through the
immediately replace, or have the component serviced. use of prescription or non-prescription drugs or medication
(even cough syrup). If you are taking any sort of drug or
5. The vehicle identification plates are the only legal medication, be sure that it will not affect your driving ability.
identification reference; hence it is necessary to keep
them in good condition. Never modify data on the
When driving long distances, follow these tips to have a safe Mahindra uses high quality parts for building the vehicles. In
journey: the event that any parts need replacement, we recommend
that you use only Mahindra genuine parts.
• Take breaks at regular intervals
Non-Mahindra parts may harm vehicle performance and
• Lack of sleep or fatigue will impact your ability to drive will not be covered by your Mahindra warranty.
safely
• Exercise your eyes by shifting the focus of your eyes to
different parts of the road The warranty does not cover problems caused by using non
genuine parts
• Use stimulating beverages such as coffee or tea
• Relax and stay calm
Mahindra Genuine Accessories the front and rear axle. Consult Mahindra Authorised
Dealer for specific weight information
A wide selection of quality accessories are available through
your Mahindra Authorised Dealer. These accessories have • Bull bars and nudge guards are not recommended
been specifically engineered to allow you to personalize
your vehicle to suit your requirements and complement its • Accessories causing any change in vehicle specifications
style and aerodynamic appearance. like wheel rims, bull bars, etc., may affect the
performance of safety systems
Each accessory is made from high quality materials and
• Mobile communication systems such as two-way radios,
meets Mahindra's rigid engineering and safety
telephones and theft alarms that are equipped with
specifications. Every Mahindra accessory installed according
radio transmitters and installed in your vehicle should
to the Mahindra installation provisions comes with the
comply with the local regulations and should be installed
respective accessory warranty.
only by your Mahindra Authorised Dealer and can
Consult your Mahindra Authorised Dealer for detailed potentially affect the vehicle performance.
information about accessories available for your specific Vehicle Safety
model variant.
When leaving your vehicle unoccupied:
• Always remove the ignition key when you park the
For maximum vehicle performance and safety vehicle
considerations, always keep the following information in
mind: • In case of PKE, please lock and take the key fob with you
• The company shall not be liable / responsible for any • Close all the windows completely and lock all the doors
damages / injuries, including consequential damages /
injuries, resulting due to fitment of unauthorised • Do not leave any valuables in your vehicle. If you must
aftermarket accessories and / or tapping / cutting wires leave something in your vehicle, hide them and securely
in the wiring harness When adding accessories, lock all the doors
equipment, passengers and luggage to your vehicle, do
not exceed the total weight capacity of the vehicle or of
When Sleeping in Your Vehicle gear. If the engine is turned off in the middle of the
intersection or railway crossing, get someone to help you
1. Do not sleep in a parked car with closed windows. In and move the car to a safe place quickly.
particular, if you stay or sleep in the car with the
engine running and the air conditioner or heater Do not Switch off the Engine While Driving
turned on, you can suffocate to death
Do not switch off the engine while driving. Otherwise, it
2. Sleeping in a closed space with the engine running makes the steering wheel heavier, influence the brake
puts you at high risk of suffocation from the exhausts performance and consequently dangerous
3. While sleeping, you may accidentally touch the gear System Safety Mode : The protective measures including
shift lever or accelerator and thereby cause an illumination of engine warning lamp and reduced engine
accident power are taken (engine turned off in extreme case) when
4. While sleeping in the car with the engine running, you there is a critical fault in the system or a malfunction in the
may accidentally step on the accelerator, thereby major electrical or fuel system. This indicates the system
overheating the engine and exhaust pipe and causing entering the safety mode to protect the vehicle’s drive
a fire system.
Hazardous Materials: Do not store any flammable items or • If the safety mode is activated, pull over and stop the
disposable lighters in the console box or other spaces. In vehicle to a safe location immediately and contact your
hot weather, they can explode and cause a fire. Mahindra dealer. Then drive slowly or have the vehicle
towed to a Mahindra Authorised Dealer according to the
Fire Extinguisher: For safety, we strongly recommend that dealer’s instruction and have your vehicle checked by a
you have fire extinguisher in your vehicle. Keep it ready for Technician
use at any time. Be familiar with how to use it
• If you continue to drive in this state, normal driving is not
When Passing the Intersection or Railway Crossing maintained due to the fixed engine rpm and engine can
stop. But even more importantly, continued driving with
When passing the intersection or railway crossing, stop the this state may damage the drive system
vehicle to check the safety and drive through as fast as you
can while using low speed gear and without shifting the
Do Not Modify This Vehicle: If unauthorised modifications equipment might lead to damages or failures of the vehicle’s
are made on the vehicle, the company is not liable for systems.
repairing the modified parts even during the term of
warranty. Other part problems caused by modification are End of Line Disposal
also not covered. Composition: Vehicle is made from steel, Aluminum, Lead,
• The vehicle you bought is equipped with a large number Copper, Wood, other plastics & miscellaneous parts. These
of precision parts that have passed through countless materials are reusable by recycling them through a proper
experiments and tests. procedure. Some are hazardous to environment and living
beings to be disposed as per local pollution board
• These parts are deeply and systematically interwoven. regulations.
Therefore, if any part is modified or altered without
authorization, may under perform or cause critical Disposal: As batteries are made of lead, lithium & Iron
damage to the vehicle and human life phosphate with solvents as electrolyte which are harmful.
They can impact on environment and are to be disposed as
Protecting Our Environment: As a responsible citizens, all per local pollution board regulations. Certain components
of us have an important role to play in protecting our of this vehicle such as seat belt pre-tensioner, airbag and
environment. Judicious vehicle usage and ensuring battery may contain hazardous material. Special handling
hazardous waste disposal (including cleaning and may be required for service or vehicle end-of-life disposal.
lubrication fluids) are important steps towards this initiative.
Similarly ABS & other plastic panels, materials used are to
Body Repairs: If your vehicle is in a collision, contact be disposed to accredited agencies for recycling.
Mahindra Authorised Dealer to ensure that it is repaired
with Mahindra Genuine Parts. Mahindra has collision repair Most of other materials are reusable, hence components
centers that meet strict requirements for training, are to be segregated as per their composition as hazardous
equipment, quality, and customer satisfaction. Some repair and non-hazardous, disposed to accredited recycling
shops and insurance companies might suggest using non- agencies. Hence it is advised to contact Mahindra
original equipment to save money. However, these parts do Authorised Dealer for further information
not meet Mahindra’s high standards for quality, fit and
corrosion resistance. In addition, non-genuine parts or
MANUFACTURED BY
MAHINDRA & MAHINDRA LTD.
xxxxxxxxxxx
x
MODEL
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
xxxxxxxx
VEHICLE SR. NO.
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX
ENGINE NO
XXXXXXXXXX
A B C D
A B C D E F
M P O N M L K
W62A02 *- if equipped
A B C D A
B
C
CRUISE
SET+
VOL +
ENTER
SET-
RESUME
START
Cruise
ENGINE
STOP
3
2
1
+
SET
-
+ AUTO
A/C
G
MAX REAR
MODE
A/C
- A/C
OFF
NO OFF
USB
+ AUTO
G E
DUAL A/C
MAX REAR
MODE
A/C
- A/C
OFF
L
+
VOL
-
SEEK
F E D
ON OFF OFF
DRIVE
MODE F
K A Lighting Control Stalk
J I H B Driver Side Switch Bank*
C Power Seat Controls*
A Glove Box G Engine START/STOP Button* D Driver Door Switch Bank
B Infotainment Display H USB Ports E Accelerator/Brake/Clutch Pedal*
C Speakers I Rear USB Power Outlet F Driver Seat Lumber Adjustment*
D Steering Wheel J Wireless Charger G Cruise/Cluster Control Switches*
E Hood Opening Lever K Center Fascia Switch
W62A07 F Steering Control - Audio L HVAC Controls* *- if equipped
F C
C
G
D
H
E
I
Required Equipment
How to disconnect Alexa Voice Services in your XUV700
• Mobile phone
• Active Amazon Account Open the dashboard menu and go to Alexa > Alexa Settings > Sign-out and click "Confirm".
• Preferred mobile number entered during the KYC process will W62A15
• After entering valid OTP, click on “Verify My account” Change your password
• On successful verification you will be notified with a To Change your password on app if you are already logged in:
message " Account Verified"
• Tap on the top Left corner from home screen
• You will be directed to "Terms and Condition" with "I
Agree" option on successful authentication • Click on My Account and select Change Password
• Page will open with Old password, New password and Confirm
password fields
1.12.3 Forgot/Change Password and Change Pin
• Fill all the required field and tap on save button
This Feature allows the existing user to change Password and
change PIN.
In case user forgets the Password and PIN below flow helps to
create PIN and password.
FEATURE DESCRIPTION
Alerts
When your car exceeds the set speed limit. This speed limit value can be set under alert
Over Speed Alert
configuration in mobile application
High Engine Temperature Alert Alerts when Engine temperature beyond the predefined limit
Tyre Pressure Alert Alerts on excessive/very low and high tyre pressure and navigate to nearby petrol station
Alerts when vehicle park lamp left in ON condition while locking the vehicle
Lamp Status Alert Notifies when the vehicle park lamp is left in ON condition and helps to turn OFF remotely
via mobile application
Vehicle Start/Stop Alert Notifies when normal vehicle start /stop event is detected
Notifies when any of the doors open while vehicle is moving and also when you trigger for
Door Open Alert
door lock and the door remains open unintentionally
Alerts when your vehicle moves out of a set boundary area
Geo-Fence Alert Helps you to create virtual boundary for any region and will be notified whenever your
vehicle moves in or out of that boundary
Unauthorised vehicle entry Alerts the user when any unauthorized entry in the vehicle is detected
Alert
Identifies low fuel level and notifies in your mobile application. Helps you to nearby fuel
Low Fuel Alert
station
Route Deviation Alert Alerts the user when the vehicle deviates from the pre-defined path
Time Fencing Alert Notifies you when any movement of vehicle is detected during set time period
FEATURE DESCRIPTION
Notifies you whenever the driver/ co-driver is not wearing the seat belt during vehicle
Seat Belt Alert movement in mobile application
Driver Drowsiness Alert Alerts the user when the driver is detected to be drowsy while driving
Suggests in advance to renew the Insurance as expiry date of Insurance approaches
Insurance expiry Alert
Notifies you in advance when the insurance is about to expire
PUC expiry Alert Notifies you in advance when the PUC is about to expire
Alerts when engine idling is detected for a set period of time. Time can be configured in
Engine Idle Alert
mobile application
Service reminder This feature alert’s the user for service due
PKE / RKE low battery alert This feature alert’s the user when key battery is low
Low DEF alert This feature alert’s the user when DEF level is low
DPF choke alert This feature alert’s the user when Diesel Particulate filter is about to choke
Brake pad wear alert This feature alert’s the user when Front Brake Pad is worn out
Park brake not applied alert This feature alert’s the user when he/she forgets to apply park brake after parking the
vehicle
Location Based Service
GPS based vehicle tracking system for tracking vehicle’s location anywhere and at any
point of time
Live tracking
Helps to provide the real time vehicle location when vehicle is in movement
Helps in sharing the vehicle location for a set time to your family and friends
Save Route / Save Place Provision to save a route /place
Find my car Helps to identify the vehicle’s location and directs you to locate your vehicle
FEATURE DESCRIPTION
Share my car location Share your car's location with friends and family
Push to car Allows the user to push routes/location from the mobile app to the vehicle
Sync location on SUV Provides updates of any upcoming event by syncing with the calendar
Ecosense Provides the details about the driving behavior for each trip
Based on Eco score, The user’s driving pattern will be ranked for Country, state & district
Eco Sence Leader Board
wise
Trip History Provides detailed information about the trips
Weekly Report Provides details about various vehicle parameters for a defined time period
Trip Replay Provides glimpse of the trip in a form of a short video
Provides information and navigational access to nearby restaurant, ATM, Mahindra
Pit Stops
Dealership and so on
Read Vehicle Status
Check door status Allows the user to view the current status of the vehicle door
Check tyre pressure Allows the user to view the current status of tyre pressure
Check lamp status Allows the user to view the current status of the lamp
Check ODO Allows the customer to check the odometer of the vehicle
My SUV info Essential information about the vehicle like VIN, Variant and so on
Check AC Status Allows the user to view the current status of the AC
Check Distance to empty Helps to check distance to empty range i.e. the distance can be covered with the available
fuel
Seat Belt Status Helps the user to check the Driver/Co-Driver seat belt is buckled or not
Safety
FEATURE DESCRIPTION
In case of accident, Emergency call will be triggered from vehicle, SMS will be sent to With
E-Call You Hamesha & Emergency contacts along with the current vehicle location.
In case of SOS is initiated, SOS call will be triggered from vehicle, SMS will be sent to With
SOS Button You Hamesha & Emergency contacts along with the current vehicle location
Road Side Assistance Allows the user to reach out for help in case of vehicle breakdown
Remote Function
Remote Skyroof control Allows the user to remotely control Skyroof using mobile app
Remote Start/ Stop Allows the user to remotely start or stop the vehicle using mobile app
Allows the user to remotely configure the in- vehicle temperature during remote start
Remote Climate control using mobile app
Remote Window Up/Down Allows the user to remotely control the Driver window (with anti-pinch) using mobile app
Provide access to the vehicle by remotely locking and unlocking the doors when vehicle is
Remote Door Lock/Unlock stationary
Remote Lamp On/Off Allows the user to remotely turn on or off the lamps using mobile app
Locate my SUV Allows the user to remotely locate the vehicle by turning on the horn and lights
APK Features
Horoscope Allows the user to view daily fortune as per his/her zodiac sign.
Just dial Allows the user to search for various services using the Just Dial app in the infotainment
Allows the user to search for various restaurants and cuisines using Zomato app in the
Zomato
infotainment
India Today Allows the user to browse through news using India Today app in the infotainment
FEATURE DESCRIPTION
Weather Update Allows the user to view weather information using the Accuweather app in the
infotainment
Travel Explorer Allows the user to search for amusement places and more using the Travel Advisor app in
the infotainment
Others
Allows the user to know the Estimated Time of Arrival of your vehicle at your current
ETA
mobile location.
Allows the user to check the vehicle status and perform remote function using Alexa (voice
In-Home Alexa commands)
Allows the user to set the vehicle in a predefined state when giving the vehicle for valet
Valet Mode parking. The default PIN to access the Valet mode will be 1234
Any Query / Enquiry about the product, Get info on Mahindra. Send an Inquiry on any car
Contact us model. Dealers will get back to the customer on details
Smart Home Control Allows the user to control the smart appliances via vehicle location
Maintains a systematic log of the all the fuel filling events and provides a clear
Log Book - Fuel(Fuel Diary)
representation of the fuel filled and the amount spent
Greetings Greetings to the user on special occasions
Avoids distraction while driving by not pushing any AdrenoX Connect app notification
Do-Not Disturb
when mobile is detected in the vehicle
Journey Planner Allows the user to plan a journey by providing some basic information
Request app Access Allows the user to share the vehicle access to two more users
My Documents Storage and retrieval of documents such as Driving license, Insurance, PUC etc
Allows the user to connect the mobile app profiles with the vehicle profile thereby
Profile Manager
providing sync between both
FEATURE DESCRIPTION
Allows the user to create time based/location- based events that remind the user at the
To-do list specified time
Allows the user to perform all the read and remote functions through the smart watch
Smart Wearables (applicable for both Android and iOS)
Pick up Reminder Allows the user to create an event that reminds the user at the specified time
Service Booking Allows the user to schedule a service by directing to the With You Hamesha app
Alerts the user via a personalised beloved ones voice prompt when the vehicle crosses the
Personalised Safety Alert
speed limit
This Feature helps to check the toll amount for the selected route & toll amount can be
Toll Dairy recharged via Adrenox App as well. Feature also provides you alert whenever your toll
balances goes low.
Personalised welcome message, which will be configurable by the user & he/she will be
Personalised Greetings
welcomed with the audio uploaded by them (Ex: Kids voice, Fav music, Fav hero dialogues)
Feature Auto Suggestion This Feature analysis user last 3 months feature usage pattern & suggest user on the non
—utilised feature.
Mahindra – Lens This feature is Visual search tool to know your XUV700 tell tail lights better
This feature helps the customer to connect with Mahindra executive for any queries/
Ask Mahindra support related to vehicle.
2 SEATS AND SAFETY • Adjust your seat and seat back angle such that your
wrists rest on the steering wheel
2.1 Seats
• Ensure your legs are in bent position while fully
depressing the clutch pedal
Sitting in Correct Position
0
W12E01
Front Seat Height Adjustment Driver Seat Lumbar Adjustment (if equipped)
To RAISE the seat height, operate the seat height adjust Properly adjusted lumbar support provides adequate back
handle in the upward direction. Repeat this till the desired support essential during long journeys.
height is achieved.
To LOWER the seat height, push down the seat height adjust
handle while seated in the driver seat. Repeat this operation Do not use force, rotate the lumbar adjustment knob
until the desired seat height is reached beyond the extreme stop positions in either direction.
– There are objects on the seat, such as a child seat, Seat Ventilation Control:
newspapers, Plastic bags.
The Seat Ventilation Setting accessible through Infotainment
• Never use a solvent to clean the seats, including petrol, HVAC application or from footer selection of the
paint thinner, benzene, alcohol or alcohol-based infotainment Launcher Screen.
products.
Once the application has been launched, the footer
• The battery can be discharged if the seat ventilation selection will result in NO ACTION.
system is used for a long time with the ignition mode ON
and without engine running • Go to setting page in infotainment Screen then select
climate control.
• In above condition, the ventilated seat will operate for a
short period of time and will be turned off for better • Enable the Driver and Co-driver seat ventilation feature
functionality of ventilation fan based on the requirement.
Once enable the seat ventilation, user will be able to modify Again, a short press on the same icon will enable the feature
the airflow with three different level. The default level will be with Last stored Level.
OFF.
For every short press on the seat ventilation icon, the levels
shall be changed by one step to another step like Level 3
→Level 2 → Level 1 → OFF →Level 1 → Level 2 →Level 3→
Level 2 →Level 3 → OFF
The long press on the Seat Ventilation Icon, to turn it OFF.
Power Seat with Memory (Driver Side only) (if Memory Functions
equipped): The power seat switches are provided on the
driver door panel. The driver seat is equipped with a memory function, which
allows you to save and recall seat and rearview mirror
settings for up to three different drivers. The memory
function is operated by a button located on the driver’s side
door.
3 The Power seat provides
2 advanced 6-way electrical Seat Adjustment ORVM Adjustment
1 adjustments for the driver
M
Lift Recline seat.
Slider
Driver Seat and ORVM Memory Setting (If equipped) saved. The ORVM can be positioned by the user and stored
in the same switch.
1. Turn Ignition ON
2. Adjust the Seat to your desired position
3. Adjust the ORVM to your desired position
• The driver seat always move to its most rearward point
of travel regardless of the current position
4. Short Press the M button followed by desired memory • The final seat position will not be always the same when
button assigning (1, 2 or 3) using easy access function. There will be some
differences within the acceptable range depending on
the occupant's weight and vehicle power supply status.
This is completely normal and not a fault
3
2
• Make sure that the parking brake is applied before
1
adjusting the seat position or operating easy access
function so that the vehicle cannot move
M
• Do not operate seat memory switch or other switch while
the easy access function is activated as it can cause
malfunctioning of the easy access function
5. Stored your preferred Seating and ORVM position to
memory, and you will get acoustic confirmation (chime)
from cluster • If the outside rearview mirror control switch is operated
while setting up the driver seat and outside rearview
mirror position, the memory setting will be cancelled.
If ORVM adjustment is skipped and memory switches are • If you do not press any memory switch within 5 seconds,.
pressed ORVM position at that instance of time will be after pressing the driver seat position memory switch,
the memory setting will be cancelled
Restoring Seat and ORVM Position Easy Entry and Easy Exit
The Driver seat is equipped with easy entry and exit
In Ignition ON condition,
function. This helps user to enter and exit the vehicle by
user needs to press and
moving the seat backwards and downwards automatically in
hold any restore button (1,
3 Ignition OFF and driver door open conditions. This can be
2 or 3) shall take the Seat
2 enabled or disabled through the infotainment
1
and ORVM to previously
M
stored memory location
and you will get acoustic
confirmation (chime) from In Easy Entry and Easy Exit function, when the door is closed,
cluster. seat will go back to the same position as it was before opening
the door.
In Ignition OFF condition, user needs to short pressing/press
and hold any restore button (1, 2 or 3) shall take the Seat to Activation and deactivation:
previously stored memory location. During memory restore
operation, pressing any seat switch shall stop ongoing seat
movement.
2.1.2 Second Row Seats Second Row Seat Recline (if equipped)
Loading luggage on the seats is dangerous. The luggage can When returning the rear-reclined seat back to its upright
become a projectile that could hit and injure passengers in position, make sure you support the seat back while
a sudden stop or collision. Luggage should always be kept operating the lever.
on the floor.
Z12B34 Z12B35
downward of the vehicle (>45 kg) until the two latches Be cautious when placing your hands around the seat
underneath the seat lock onto the floor. anchors. You could pinch your hands or fingers between the
seat anchor and the seat. Hold the edge of the seat when
lowering it into place. Never place your hands between the
seat anchor and the seat
Second Row Seat Folding (For Luggage) Second Row Armrest (If equipped)
The Second Row 60P seat features armrest with cup holder.
The 2nd Row 60P seat back • To open the armrest, simply pull on the tab given at the
can be folded to load cargo top of the armrest (as shown).
on top of it. Operate the
lever on the side of the 60P • When armrest is not required, push back the armrest
seat. This lever actuates the into the 60P backrest.
backrest fold mechanism.
Release the lever once the
backrest has folded
completely.
To bring the seat back to upright position and push the seat
back until it locks into the desired reclining position.
Second Row Captain Seat arm rest fold and unfold (If Second Row Bench Seat (If equipped)
equipped)
The second row seat can be folded forward to increase
luggage space.
• Pull the strap rearwards to unlock the seat back as shown
in below image
• Then push the backrest forwards to fold it.
• To open the seat back, simply pull the backrest rearwards
until it gets locked in position.
Similarly, lower the other half of third row seat to get a The head restraint comprises the padded portion which
completely flat surface. Both the second row and third row contacts your head and is inserted/locked in receptacles on the
seats can be folded flat to maximise the luggage space. top of the seat back. Vehicle seats are equipped with head
restraints which are vertically adjustable. The purpose of these
head restraints is to help limit head motion in the event of rear
collision.
• Seat belts should be adjusted as tightly as possible, protection provided by the seat belt and increase the chance
consistent with comfort to properly secure the wearer in the of serious injury in a crash
seat.
• An accident or emergency stop, can damage your seat belt
system, even if the accident is “minor”. Please have your
Mahindra Authorised Dealer inspect the seat belt system
after an accident
• Please be aware that any unsecured item in your vehicle,
such as your pet, unsecured child restraint system, a laptop
or mobile phones, can become a projectile in the event of an
accident or sudden stop, causing injuries to occupants in the
U22E11
U22E10
vehicle
• The seat belts provided for your vehicle are designed for Never use a damaged seat belt system. A damaged seat belt
adults must be properly used and maintained. will not provide protection in an accident, resulting in serious
injury.
• For usage of adult seat belt to secure children, refer to
section of manual for child seat positions and use a child • Seat belt systems are prone to abuse. They are not
restraint systems indestructible. They must be handled with care to avoid
damage
• Passengers should not move out of or change seats while
the vehicle is in motion. Passenger who does not wear the • Keep the belts clean and dry. Belt retraction may become
seat belts will be under a high risk of thrown against the difficult if the belts and webbings are soiled. If they need
vehicle inside hard parts, against other occupants or out of cleaning, use a mild soap solution or lukewarm water.
the vehicle during emergency stop or collision. Never use bleach, dye, or abrasive cleaners. These
chemicals will severely weaken the belts
• Do not use any accessories on seat belts or modify in any
way the seat belt system. Devices claiming to improve • Retractors in 3-point type seat belts retract the seat belts
occupant comfort or reposition the seat belt can reduce the when not in use. The inertia lock and coil spring allow the
belts to remain comfortable on users during normal driving. 2. Open Pillar trims and take out Seat belt assembly on
During accidents or abrupt stops, inertia locks restrict the bench by carefully disassembly of connector and Lap
sudden forward movement of the wearer Pretensioner/ Anchor wire assembly (if equipped). Kindly
Prevention of seat belt Slow retraction: follow correct safety belt pretensioner handling procedure
in case of pretensioner safety belts. Use clean and lint free
1. Check if there any twist on in-board or out-board side of cloth and hand gloves for cleaning safety belt assembly. Do
safety belt. not use any chemicals and cleaning fluids could damage the
Seat belt webbing and other parts.
2. Check if dust accumulated on outer parts such as
Webbing , D-Loop, Tongue stopper and Tongue. 3. If seat belt movement is sticky due to dust accumulation.
Then please contact the dealer for help in cleaning.
3. Remove the dust from D-Loop, Webbing, Tongue &
Tongue stopper by compressed air or air blower. 4. In case of soiling on the belt, use a mild soap solution
consisting of 2 tablespoons of natural soap to 1 liter of
4. Use clean and lint free cloth and hand gloves for cleaning lukewarm water.
safety belt parts D-Loop, Webbing, Tongue & Tongue
stopper. Do not use any chemicals and cleaning fluids could 5. Care to be taken to prevent contact of soap water with
damage the seat belt assembly. Pretensioner .
5. Inspect the Webbing for retraction performance. Safety 6. Clean dust accumulated on D-Loop, Webbing and overall
belt assembly cleaning required if seat belt retraction assembly by close inspection of D-Loop and Webbing using
becomes very slow due to dust and soil accumulation on lint free cloth.
safety belt assembly, then below cleaning procedure to be
followed: 7. After cleaning safety belt they should be dried by lint free
dry cloth.
1. Appropriate Procedure of disassembly of all pyrotechnic
devices to be followed for pretensioner seat belt. The 8. After cleaning kindly inspect Webbing movement through
Battery terminal to be removed before disassembly of D-Loop slot for any sticky movement of webbing .
pretensioner, otherwise there will be error codes registered 9. Assemble the safety belt using correct torque. Re-
in Airbag ECU and Airbag ECU will show malfunction. assemble all trim parts.
10. Inspect the Webbing for retraction performance. Each seat belt is meant for use by one person only. Using
one seat belt for more than one person at a time is
Seat Belts - Patients: Persons with serious medical dangerous. The seat belt will not be able to absorb the
conditions should also wear a seat belt. Consult your doctor for impact forces properly leading to serious injuries.
specific recommendations before travel.
Never wear a belt around a child being carried on the
Seat Belts - Pregnant Women: Pregnant women must also occupant's lap. This could lead to serious injuries.
wear seat belts. Consult your doctor for specific
recommendations. Seat Belt Usage is Necessary to:
• Reduce the possibility of being out from your vehicle
The lap belt should be worn during an accident.
snugly and as low as possible
over the hips. The shoulder • Reduce the possibility of injuries to upper body, lower
belt should be worn across body and legs during an accident
your shoulder, but never
across the stomach area.
• Hold the driver in a position which allows better control
When worn properly, the of the vehicle
seat belt will protect both the Children who are too large for child restraint systems
W12E22
mother and the foetus in an should always occupy the rear seat and use the vehicle seat
accident or emergency stop. belts. The lap portion should be snug fastened on the hips
and as low as possible and the shoulder belt should be rout
across the child's shoulder, not across neck or face. If you
are unable to position the belt across the child's shoulder,
A pregnant woman should never wear the seat belt across the child should be seated in a booster seat. Frequently
the stomach area. This could lead to serious injuries to the check the seat belt to be sure it remains snug and in
foetus and/or the pregnant mother. position. A squirming child could cause the seat belt to
Never wear twisted seat belts. Excessive forces will be come out of position.
transferred from the belt to the wearer, in a collision,
resulting in serious personal injury.
2.3.2 Seat Belt Configuration 2nd Row Captain Seat belt with Emergency Lock Retractor
Seat LH / RH (ELR)
Seat belt with Emergency Lock Retractor
3rd Row LH / RH (ELR)
centre W12E24
Periodically check the seat belt as you ride to be sure it smoothly, pull it out and check for kinks or twists. Then
remains snug and in position. If there is a sudden stop or make sure it remains untwisted as it retracts.
impact, the belt will lock into position. It will also lock
(restrict) if you try to lean forward too quickly.
Never insert coins, clips, etc. in the buckle as this may
prevent from properly latching the tongue and may cause
If the driver or co-driver seat belt is not fastened when the damage to the buckle mechanism, thereby making the seat
ignition is switched ON, the seat belt warning lamp belt ineffective in an accident, resulting in serious personal
illuminates and chimes beat will turn till seat belt fastened. injury.
Refer “Warning Lamps” in the “Instrument Cluster Features”
chapter for further details. 2.3.6 Driver and Passenger Seat Belt Reminder
Indication (If equipped)
2.3.5 Seat Belt Release
The driver, co-driver and front facing rear
passenger seat belt reminder warning symbol
lamp will blink in instrument cluster if driver
doesn’t wear the seat belt and will be continuous until belt is
buckled.
PR
2.3.7 Passenger Occupant Detection System (PODS) Do keep in mind that after market seat covers also may
& Seat Belt Reminder Indication (If equipped) deteriorate the detection senor performance, don’t use the
non recommended/non authorized seat covers.
2.3.8 Seat Belt Height Adjuster 2.4 Child Restraint System (CRS)
• When using the “ISOFIX” lower latch system (rod), all unused 3. Connect the tether connector in child restraint to the
vehicle rear seat belt metal latch plates or tabs must be latched top tether rod/ rear anchor. Securely tighten the child
securely in their seat belt buckles and the seat belt webbing restraint by adjusting the webbing of the child
must be retracted behind the child restraint to prevent the restraint system (CRS) tether connector. Follow the
child from reaching and taking hold of un-retracted seat belts. clear instructions provide in the CRS manual
Unlatched metal latch plates or tabs may allow the child to
reach the un-retracted seat belts which may result in
strangulation and a serious injury or death to the child in the
child restraint. • The top-tether/ rear anchor is the supplemental device to
• Child restraint anchorages are designed to withstand only secure the child restraint system after engaging it by the
those loads imposed by correctly-fitted child restraints. Under ISOFIX rod/lower latches. Therefore, do not secure the
no circumstances are they to be used for adult seat belts, child restraint system only with the seat back anchors.
harnesses or for attaching other items or equipment to the The increased load may cause the hooks or anchors to
vehicle break, causing serious injury or death.
How to use the Top Tether/Rear Anchor • If a child restraint is not properly secured to the vehicle
and a child is not properly restrained in the child
restraint, the child could be seriously injured or killed in
a collision. Always follow the instructions provided by the
manufacturer for installation
There are two top tether
rods/rear anchors on the • Make sure the latches of the child restraint system are
seat base back side of the Firmly latched to the ISOFIX rod/lower latches. In this
rear row front facing seats. case, you can hear the “click” sound/ latch indications
provided on seat.
W62D25 • Incorrectly installed child restraint system may cause an
unexpected personal injury.
1. Remove the headrest from the rear row seat
Table of Information on Child Restraint Systems (CRS) Using The Seat Belt
TYPE B
TYPEA
Seating position
Passenger Seat Second Row Third Row
Restraint Mounting
Mass group Deactivated method of
Device Figure Activated front front Cen-
Passenger Left Right Left Right vehicle
Passenger tre
Airbag
Airbag
Group 0 Rear Facing 3 - Point Seat
Up to 10 kg X U U X U X X
Child Seat Belt
Group 0+ Rear Facing 3 - Point Seat
Up to 13 kg X U U X U X X
Child Seat Belt
Group I Forward
3 - Point Seat
9 to 18 kg Facing Child U X U X U X X
Belt
Seat
Group II 3 - Point Seat
15 to 25 kg Booster Seat U X U X U X X
Belt
Group III 3 - Point Seat
22 to 36 kg Booster Seat U X U X U X X
Belt
Table of Information on Child Restraint Systems (CRS) Using ISOFIX & Top Tether
TYPE B
TYPEA
Seating position
Restraint Mounting
Mass group First Row Second Row Third Row method of
Device Figure
Left Left Centre Right Left Right vehicle
Group 0 Rear Facing ISOFIX & Top
Up to 10 kg X IU X IU X X
Child Seat Tether
Group 0+ Rear Facing ISOFIX & Top
Up to 13 kg X IU X IU X X
Child Seat Tether
Group I Forward Facing ISOFIX & Top
9 to 18 kg X IU/IUF X IU/IUF X X
Child Seat Tether
Group II ISOFIX & Top
15 to 25 kg Booster Seat X IUF X IUF X X
Tether
Group III ISOFIX & Top
22 to 36 kg Booster Seat X IUF X IUF X X
Tether
Table of Information on ISOFIX Child Restraint Systems Installation Suitability for Various ISOFIX Positions
TYPE B
TYPEA
Table of Vehicle Handbook Information on ISOFIX Child Restraint Systems Installation Suitability for Various ISOFIX
Positions
Warning for Child Restraint procedure and use instructions provided by the
manufacturer of the booster seat.
• Use only the approved Child Restraint System (CRS) for
better safety of your child. Cautions for ISOFIX Seat usage
• Mahindra is not responsible for the personal injury and • The anchor provided on rear seat base back is the
property damage due to the defect of child restraint supplemental device to secure the child restraint system after
system. engaging it by the lower latches. Therefore, do not secure the
child restraint system only with the seat back anchors. The
• Use the proper type of child restraint system suitable for increased load may cause the hooks or anchors to break,
the weight and size for your baby. causing serious injury or death.
• Use the child restraint system at recommended seating • If a child restraint is not properly secured to the vehicle and a
location only and follow the instructions. child is not properly restrained in the child restraint, the child
could be seriously injured or killed in a collision. Always follow
• Child restraint has 5 categories based on the weight as the instructions provided by the manufacturer for installation.
below:
• Make sure the latches of the child restraint system are latched
1 GROUP 0 : 0 ~ 10 KG 4 GROUP II : 15 ~ 25 KG to the lower latches. In this case, you can hear the “click” sound
and color indications.
2 GROUP 0+ : 0 ~ 13 KG 5 GROUP III : 22 ~ 36 KG
• The child restraint seat strap may not work properly if attached
3 GROUP I : 9 ~ 18 KG somewhere other than the correct seat back anchor provided
on the rear seat base back side behind the seat carpet. Follow
• Group 0 & 0 + : Rear-facing child restraint fitted on the the instructions provided on the seat back for the details of
rear seat (use of ISOFIX with Base & Support Leg is anchor location.
recommended).
• Make sure that the child restraint system is firmly secured by
• Group I: Forward-facing child restraint fitted on the rear rocking it in different directions.
seat (use of ISOFIX & Top Tether is recommended).
• Incorrectly installed child restraint system may cause an
• Group II & III: Booster seat fitted on the rear seat with unexpected personal injury.
seat belt fastened. Always follow the installation
The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) includes airbags, Your vehicle has the following airbags:
pre-tensioners and ECU. The airbags are designed to
provide further protection to the vehicle occupants in A: Knee airbag for the
addition to the primary protection provided by the seat driver (if equipped)
belts and seat belt pre-tensioners. E
B: Front Passenger Airbag
E
The primary components of the system are the sensors C: Driver Airbag
which measure the crash severity. In the event of a D
significant frontal impact, the SRS airbags inflate to work in C
B D:Two side (seat) impact
D
conjunction with the seat belts and help reduce injuries airbags (if equipped)
mainly to the driver's or front passenger's head/chest. A E: Two curtain airbags (if
W62B03
equipped)
Driver Airbag
Do not place any objects over the airbag or between the airbag
and yourself. It cause injuries.
RESUME
START
ENGINE
STOP
3
2
1
The driver’s knee airbag is located on the dashboard under the
steering wheel
REAR
A/C ECON
A/C
NO OFF W12F01
START
ENGINE
USB STOP
REAR
A/C ECON
A/C
SET+
VOL + ENTER
SET-
RESUME
START
ENGINE
STOP
3
2
1
NO OFF
+ AUTO DUAL
A/C
MODE
MAX
- REAR
REAR
OFF
A/C ECON
A/C A/C
A/C
USB
DRIVE
NO OFF OFF MODE
USB
SET+
VOL +
ENTER
SET-
RESUME
START
ENGINE
STOP
3
2
1
If the driver’s posture is improper while driving, the knee air bag
REAR
A/C ECON
A/C
NO OFF W12F02
might not protect the driver’s knee area when the airbag deployed.
USB
2.5.3 Side Impact Airbag (If equipped) your body too close to airbag, you or especially children could be
seriously injured/killed by a deploying airbag.
Your vehicle is equipped
with side impact airbag in
both the front seats. The • In the case of a side collision, the curtain airbag may be
purpose of the airbag is to deployed together with the relevant side airbag on the side the
provide the vehicle's driver collision occurs
and/or the front passenger
with additional protection • The side impact airbag is supplementary to the seat belt
during side impacts or systems and is not a substitute for them. Therefore, your seat
belts must be worn at all times while the vehicle is in motion.
collisions.
The airbags deploy only in certain side impact conditions
severe enough to cause significant injury to the vehicle
occupants
• For best protection from the side impact airbag system and to
avoid being injured by the deploying side impact airbag, all
seat occupants should sit in an upright position with the seat
belt properly fastened. The driver's hands should be placed on
the steering wheel at the 9:00 and 3:00 positions. The
passengers arms and hands should be placed on their laps
• Do not use any accessory seat covers. Use of seat covers could
reduce or prevent the effectiveness of the system
The side impact airbags are designed to deploy only during certain
side-impact collisions, depending on the crash severity, angle, • Do not install any accessories on the side or near the side
speed and point of impact. To minimise the risk of severe injury in impact airbag
the event of a crash, every passenger must always wear their seat
belt (see the chapter on Seat Belts in this manual). The airbags
• Do not place any objects over the airbag or between the air bag
and yourself
inflate very quickly with great force. Do not position any part of
• Do not place any objects (an umbrella, bag, etc.) between the
door and the seat. Such objects may become dangerous
projectiles and cause injury if the supplementary side impact
airbag inflates
Do not cover the front seats with anything. It hinders the air bag
inflation
The Side Curtain air bags are located along sides of the roof rails • When children are seated in the rear outboard seats, they must
on the A & B pillars. They are designed to help protect the heads of be seated in the proper child restraint system. Make sure to
the front seat occupants and the rear outboard seat occupants in position the child restraint system as far away from the door
certain side impact collisions. The curtain airbag are designed to side as possible, and secure the child restraint system in a
deploy depending on the crash severity, angle, speed and impact. locked position
The curtain airbag are not designed to deploy in all side impact
situations, collisions from the front or rear of the vehicle or in
• Do not allow the passengers to lean their heads or bodies onto
doors or place objects between the doors and passengers when
rollover situations.
they are seated on seats equipped with side and/or curtain
airbag
2.5.5 Passenger Airbag Activation/Deactivation If your select Airbag ON/OFF the following indicator will
appear.
The passenger air bag activation/deactivation option is
available in instrument cluster menu. Passenger Airbag OFF Indicator
Select Passenger Airbag Activation/Deactivation option in This Warning indicator glows on center fascia
SETTINGS menu to activate/deactivate (not inflatable) the switch on IP when passenger airbag “OFF”
front passenger airbag as per below reference images position.
Passenger Airbag ON Indicator
This Warning indicator symbol glows on center
CRUISE
fascia switch on IP when selecting the
+
passenger airbag “ON” option to enable the
SET
-
passenger airbag.
RESUME
2.5.6 Airbag System Malfunction Lamp
If either of the following conditions occur, there is a thorough inspection of the airbag and seat belt systems, no
malfunction of the airbags or seat belt pre-tensioner. matter how minor the accident. The airbag system could
Immediately contact your Mahindra Authorised Dealer. have been damaged, and may not work as intended in the
future, resulting in serious injury.
• The lamp does not glow when the ignition is switched ON
or glows beyond six (6) seconds after switching the
ignition ON 2.5.7 Airbag Inflation/Deployment
• The lamp comes ON at any other time, even briefly The airbag sensors constantly monitor the forward
• The lamp comes ON intermittently deceleration of the vehicle. If an impact results in a forward
deceleration beyond the designed threshold level, the
system triggers the airbag inflators. This initiates a chemical
reaction which quickly fills the airbags with non-toxic gas.
Never make any modifications to your vehicle which could
affect the performance of airbag system. In particular, Upon deployment, tear seams moulded directly into the pad
changes to the vehicle frame, bumpers, bull bar, front covers separate under pressure from the expansion of the
fenders, ride height, suspension, seat belts, interior trim, airbags. Further opening of the covers allows full inflation of
seats or steering wheel (especially covers, pads or other the airbags. A fully inflated airbag, in combination with a
trim), could prevent proper deployment of the airbag. If you properly worn seat belt, slows the driver's or the
need to make any modifications to accommodate any passenger's forward motion, reducing the risk of head and
disability you may have, please contact your Mahindra chest injury.
Authorised Dealer..
After complete inflation, the airbag immediately starts
Never try to open or strike the airbag cover. If the airbag deflating, enabling the driver to maintain forward visibility
cover is cracked or damaged in any way, the airbag may not and the ability to manoeuvre or operate other controls.
function as intended. Take the vehicle to an Mahindra
Authorised Dealer. Deployment of the airbags happen in a milliseconds,
producing a loud noise releasing a ‘white smoke’ and
Even if the airbags do not deploy during an accident, take residue along with a non-toxic gas. This does not indicate a
your vehicle to an Mahindra Authorised Dealer for a fire. This smoke may remain inside the vehicle for some
time, and may cause some minor irritation to the eyes, skin usually in the nature of minor burns or abrasions and
or breathing. Be sure to wash off any residue with soap and swelling, but the force of a deploying airbag can also
water as soon as possible to prevent any potential skin cause more serious injuries, especially if an occupant's
irritation. Exit the vehicle as soon as possible after the hands, arms, chest or head is in close proximity to the
accident. airbag module at the time of deployment. Sit straight
and well back into the seat. Move your seat as far back
as practical to allow room for airbag inflation, while still
Airbag deployment may cause windshield to break. allowing you to properly operate/drive the vehicle
The front passenger should never sit on the edge of the
seat, stand near the glove compartment, rest feet or other
parts of the body on the dashboard when the vehicle is
• Do not modify, remove, strike or open the seat belt pre- moving.
tensioner assemblies, airbag sensor or surrounding area
or wiring. Failure to follow these instructions may
prevent them from activating correctly, cause sudden
operation of the system or disable the system, which
could result in serious injury
• Parts of the airbag module (steering wheel hub, airbag
cover and inflator) may be hot for several minutes after
deployment. The airbags inflate only once
• Do not cover the steering wheel, instrument panel, seats
with any object (e. g. dash panel covers, seat covers)
which may prevent the airbags from inflating properly The driver or front passenger who is too close to the
steering wheel or dashboard can be seriously injured during
• The airbags inflate with considerable force. While the airbag deployment.
system is designed to reduce serious injuries, primarily to
the head and chest, it may also cause other, less severe
injuries to the face, chest, arms and hands. These are
Front Airbag
Extreme Hazard! Do not use a rear-facing child restraint on a seat Front airbag are designed to inflate in a frontal collision
protected by an airbag in front of it! depending on the intensity, speed or angles of impact of the
Never put a child restraint in the front passenger’s seat. If the front front collision.
passenger airbag inflates, it can cause serious or fatal injuries.
Never hold an infant or child on your lap. The infant or child could
be seriously injured in the event of a crash. All infants and children
should be properly restrained in appropriate child safety seats or
seat belts in the rear seat.
Instal the child restraint system on the rear outboard seats, and
securely lock the child restraint system in position with the help of
ISOFIX. CORRECT SEAT BELT
POSITIONING
Always Buckle Children (ABC) in the back seat. It is the safest place
for children of any age to ride.
Impacts below a pre-determined threshold level may not Frontal offset impact to the vehicle may not provide the
cause the airbag to deploy in the following cases: deceleration force necessary for airbag deployment.
Frontal Impact : Running under a truck's tailgate may not provide the
decelerations necessary for airbag deployment.
300
Frontal impact beyond 30º
range from head-on to the Airbags will not inflate in
vehicle. this “under-ride” situation
300 where deceleration forces
that are detected by
sensors are significantly
low.
Type 1
Type 2
A B C D E
E F 5 C H
I H G F
A Tacho Gauge C Trip Computer E Speedo Gauge G Odometer I Fuel Gauge
B Time D OAT F Temperature Gauge H Gear Shift Indicator
3.1.1 Speedometer Secondary level: Buzzer will trigger periodic chime when the
vehicle speed reaches 120 kmph and chime will continue playing
High Low until vehicle speed is reduced to 114 kmph. Below this speed
primary level chime will be triggered and will continue till 76 kmph.
3.1.2 Tachometer
High Low
The fuel level gauge functions only when the ignition is switched
ON. It gives the status of the fuel level in the fuel tank. F indicates
Do not over-accelerate the engine during idling, this can cause severe the tank is full (60 +/- 2 liters), E indicates the tank is empty.
engine damage and would be treated as abuse of the engine which is
not covered by warranty. When the fuel level reaches the reserve, the last bar will be
displayed and low fuel telltale will be ON (approx 12 liters). when
the fuel tank is completely empty, last bar goes off from display
and low fuel telltale will be blinking . The amount of fuel required
Tacho red band range: to fill the tank up may be less than the specified tank capacity, as a
Gasoline 5500 - 7000 rpm small amount of reserve fuel always remains in the tank.
Diesel 5000 - 7000 rpm On inclines or curves, due to the movement of fuel in the tank, the
fuel level may fluctuate or the last bar may flash earlier than usual.
Diesel (High Variant): Tacho red band shall change based on Always check the fuel level when the vehicle is on level road. If the
engine parameters last bar is still off and telltale is blinking even after filling sufficient
fuel, contact your Mahindra Authorised Dealer as soon as possible.
3.1.3 Fuel Level Gauge
3.1.4 Temperature Gauge burns. Wait for the engine to cool down before adding coolant to the
reservoir.
The engine coolant temperature gauge functions only when the Do not continue driving the vehicle with an overheated engine. This will
ignition is switched ON. It indicates the instantaneous engine lead to damage of engine components and engine seizure.
coolant temperature. The coolant temperature varies with changes
in weather, load on engine and driving pattern.
3.1.5 Outside Ambient Temperature (if equipped)
If the gauge moves beyond the normal operating range toward “H”
mark. it indicates the engine overheating that may damage the
engine. Allow engine to cool. In such situations switch OFF the AC
and observe any improvements in the temperature gauge. If not,
stop the vehicle and allow the engine to cool down. Check the This Screen shows the
coolant level in the coolant reservoir and top-up if required. If the outside ambient
engine is still overheating, contact your nearest Mahindra temperature and we can
Authorised Dealer. change units based on
infotainment setting.
High
3 4 04:20 AM Low
Drive Info 18 oc 100 120
Trip - A 80 140
X 1000 rpm km/h
2 5 60 160
Distance 8888.8km
40 180
1 6 Time 88:88hr 3.1.6 Gear Information
Avg. Speed 220km/h 20 200
ENGINE!
7
Hold : Reset Gear information
220 shows the actual gear the vehicle is
999999km currently in.
E F 5 C H
Based on the various parameters, it will also provide an up
shift / down shift recommendation for better fuel economy.
Never remove the Degassing tank cap when the engine is hot. The engine
coolant is under pressure and could splash on to skin/eyes causing severe
The odometer records and displays the total distance The vehicle has selectable drive modes like Zip, Zap, Zoom
travelled in Km. Odometer cannot be reset. and Custom which have their own distinct pre-set
configurations. The selection of drive mode is made via
Type
3 1 4 04:20 AM Type 2
Drive Info 18 oc 100dedicated
120 button or switches.
Trip - A 80 140
X 1000 rpm km/h
2 5 60 160
Distance 8888.8km Drive selection menu part of infotainment and cluster will
1 6 Time 88:88hr 40 display the
180 current drive mode.
3.3 Instrument Cluster Control Switches The right most steering wheel switches are used to control
the instrument cluster menus.
The instrument cluster menus can be changed using the
cluster control switches on the Steering wheel or the Driver
A
side switch bank.
CRUISE
CRUISE
B
Driver side switch bank is located on the right hand side of
VOL + +
SET
-
SET+
the Instrument Panel.
VOL + RESUME
VOL +
+
C
SET-
-
RESUME
START
ENGINE
D
STOP
B A 3 RESUME
2
1 E
D C
START
ENGINE
STOP A: Menu button: Horizontal scrolling i.e., change in menu
REAR
A/C ECON
A/C
Power &
DEF Setting X Warning x
Trip B , Torque
Level**
Drive time ,
Average
speed ECO AWD
Score** Animation**
Clock &
Date
Driver ** Notice :
Attention **If equipped
level
Up button : Allows menu to navigate Anticlockwise if already menus triggered from menu button
Down button : Allows menu to navigate Clockwise if already menus triggered from menu button
REGEN**
3.5 Drive Info Trip meter can be reset by long press of OK. Resetting trip
will reset average speed and drive time associated with the
particular trip.
Drive info can be accessed
by pressing MENU button
in Steering Wheel/Driver It is recommended to reset the trip meters when battery is
side switch bank. disconnected and reconnected
Use OK button to enter
Drive info page. 3.5.2 Drive Time
Two trip meters are available with max range of 9999.9 km.
These are available in drive info menu and can be accessed
using UP/DOWN switch.
1 Attention Bars - Indicates Refer fuel emission control section for more details on Park
that the driver is extremely regeneration.
Sleepy and cant stay awake
Fuel info can be accessed by pressing MENU button in AFE is calculated based on the last AFE reset cycle.
Steering wheel/driver side switch bank.
AFE can be reset by long
press of OK button in
Steering wheel/driver side
It displays data related to switch bank.
fuel consumption pattern
of vehicle. Additional options to
change AFE reset to every
Use OK button to enter Fuel ignition ON or after every
info page. fuel refill are present in the
settings menu.
Instantaneous Fuel
Economy is calculated
based on your current
Distance to Empty is the driving pattern. Higher
approximate distance that value on display means
can be covered with the vehicle is consuming less
available fuel. fuel, lower value on display
implies it is consuming
more fuel.
3.6.4 DEF Level (If equipped) 3.7 Digital Speedo Meter (if equipped)
3.8.3 AWD Torque Distribution (If equipped) Partial Screen Navigation Turn by Turn Navigation
3.10 Driver Assistance (ADAS) (If equipped) Cluster will display the below features in Driver Assistance Menu:
1. Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) 3. Lane Keep Assist System (LKA/LDW)
Long press up button shall enter into LKAS setting (if equipped)
Refer “Advanced Driver Assistance System” chapter for more details.
3.12 Display Layout Information Skin: Cluster shall display all the information
with different visual layout.
Cluster selected Themes:
Display Layout shortcut : Long press menu button shall enter into display
layout directly
3.13 Cluster Setting (if equipped) 3.13.1 Driver Assistance (If equipped)
Above procedure is applicable for all other Driver Assistance 3. Press OK to enter AFE
features. Auto Reset option. Use Up/
Down button to navigate to
Refer to Advanced Driver Assistance System chapter for the option. Press OK to
more details. select.
4. Press OK to select a
1. Navigate to Setting menu option. Confirm your
using MENU button. selection by selecting Ok or
Cancel.
3.13.4 Blind View Monitoring (if equipped) 3.13.5 Drowsiness Detection(if equipped)
3.13.6 TPMS-Auto Learn (if equipped) 3.13.7 Tyre Fill Assist (if equipped)
3.13.8 Sound
Turn Indicators, Notifications Sound and Lane Departure 4. Use Up/Down button to
Warning (If applicable) are having options to select different navigate to the option.
sounds and Volume level adjustment. Press OK to select.
3. Press OK to Select
3. Press ok to enter Clock following screen will
Type option. Use Up/Down appear. Use Down button
button to navigate to the to select Confirm. Press OK
option. Press OK to select. to start factory reset
process.
Alert history allows to check This alert is displayed when the check
any active applicable engine warning telltale is ON and
vehicle warnings in the engine is running.
instrument cluster display.
This alert is displayed when engine This alert is displayed when low fuel
temperature high telltale is ON and warning telltale is ON or blinking and
engine is running. engine is running.
This alert is displayed when an ABS This alert is displayed when the
related malfunction is detected. engine oil pressure warning telltale is
50 ON and engine is running.
This alert is displayed when low brake This alert is displayed when either of
fluid is detected and engine is driver or passenger (if occupied)
running. seatbelt is unbuckled.
This alert is displayed when the park This alert is displayed when water is
lamp is ON and the ignition is turned detected in fuel filter and engine is
OFF. running. It is applicable for the diesel
variant only.
This alert is displayed when the ESP This alert is displayed when AWD
malfunction is detected and engine is system related malfunction is
running. detected.
This alert is displayed when EPS This alert is displayed when Zip drive
related malfunction is detected mode is activated.
<Level 0>
3.17 Tyre Direction Monitoring System (TDMS)
Tyre direction monitoring system or TDMS assists you when
vehicle has just started and you are about to move the vehicle. It
tells you about the current direction in which tyres are aligned at
very beginning of manoeuvring the vehicle. TDMS works only when
vehicle speed is zero and parking brake engaged or when vehicle
speed is zero and vehicle is in neutral and clutch is not engaged
Operating Conditions Blind view monitoring system displays the video from the
camera placed in the side mirrors when turn indicators are
Tyre alignment is displayed in 6 levels (level 0 to level 5) ON.
depending on the alignment degree when the ignition
switch is turned to "ON" position from "OFF" position Favorite Function
Working conditions: Favorite button short press, Cluster will display the screen
which was already saved as favorite
1. When vehicle speed is zero and parking brake engaged.
User can set as favorite any one of the menu screen (Vehicle
2. When vehicle speed is zero and vehicle is in neutral and info, Fuel info, Digital speed, Drive info, Navigation, Driver
clutch is not engaged. Assistance, Audio, Display Layout & Setting Level 1) except
settings (Level 2,3,4) REGEN function & Warning history.
3.18 Cluster Features
Favorite Feature Non–Favorite Feature
Blind View Monitor (If equipped)
BOOST AUTO
AEBS
BOOST OFF
ZIP
Few Tell Tales grouped in to same slot and this will be cyclic based on tell tale status.
Water-in-Fuel Warning Continuously ON Indicates water-in-fuel. Drain the water from filter or
5 No contact an Mahindra Authorised Dealer for assistance
telltale*
Low Fuel Warning Continuously ON/ Indicates fuel level has reached the reserve level. Refuel
13 No Blinking immediately
telltale
14 ESP OFF telltale* No Continuously ON Indicates ESP has been switched OFF
Seat Belt Warning If telltale is not turning OFF even after fastening the seat
18 No Continuously ON belt, contact an Mahindra Authorised Dealer for
telltale assistance
21 Glow Plug telltale* No. Continuously ON Indicates glow plugs are active.
22 Head Lamp High Beam No Continuously ON Indicates Head lamp high beam is ON
High Engine Coolant Continuously ON or Engine temperature very high. Contact Mahindra
28 Temperature Warning No Blinking Authorised Dealer immediately
telltale
ON: Regeneration is required
29 REGEN telltale* NO ON/Blink Blink: Regeneration is in progress
Automatic Emergency
AEBS Continuously ON
34 Braking System OFF No Indicates AEB system is turned off by user.
OFF
telltale*
Lane Keep Assist Continuously ON or Indicates LKA system is in Active state Blinking: LKA
35 System*(LKA) No Blinking system providing Warning to the user
Lane Departure Continuously ON or Indicates LDW system is in Active state Blinking: LDW
36 Warning System*(LDW) No Blinking system providing Warning to the user
Continuously ON or
37 Smart Pilot Assist* No Blinking
Indicates Smart Pilot Assist is in Active state
40 High Beam Assist* No Continuously ON Indicates high beam assist function is enabled/active.
AUTO
AUTO Continuously ON
41 Auto Vehicle Hold* No Indicates Auto Vehicle Hold in Active Mode.
HOLD
3.20 Warning Lamps in the Instrument Cluster 3.20.3 Water-in-Fuel Warning Lamp (if equipped)
3.20.5 Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Malfunction there is malfunction in EBD. If the lamp illuminates while
Lamp driving, do the following:
If the ABS malfunction lamp is ON when driving A fault with EBD is indicated by illumination of the brake as
ABS will not operate. But the brake system will well as ABS warning lamps.
still operate conventionally. In this condition, • Check if the parking brake/ Electric parking brake is
the wheels can lock during severe braking. Have the vehicle engaged. If yes, disengage it
checked by an Mahindra Authorised Dealer as soon as
possible. • Check if brake fluid level is low. If yes, top-up brake fluid
to the required level
However, if ABS malfunction lamp and brake warning lamp
are simultaneously glowing, there is a severe malfunction in • Check if front brake pad is worn out. If yes, replace the
the ABS. Operate the vehicle with extreme care and have front brake pads
the vehicle checked as soon as possible at an Mahindra
Authorised Dealer.
Clean the top of the brake fluid reservoir before removing the cap. Make
sure no dirt, impurities or other items fall into the reservoir. Do not leave
the cap off for more than a few minutes. Any contaminants, impurities or
if ABS malfunction lamp and parking brake warning lamp moisture in the brake fluid can affect brake operation, resulting in an
are simultaneously ON, there is a severe malfunction in the accident.
ABS. Contact a Mahindra Authorised Dealer immediately If the brake warning lamp comes ON while driving, the brake system might
not be working properly. The pedal might be harder to operate or might go
In this case, the ABS function is not available, but the closer to the floor and it can take longer to stop. Pull off the road carefully
conventional brake system is properly working and stop the vehicle. Have the vehicle towed to the nearest Mahindra
Authorised Dealer for checks or repairs.
Driving the vehicle with the brake warning lamp ON or when you suspect
3.20.6 Parking Brake Lamp brake trouble is very dangerous and could result in serious injuries. Have
your vehicle towed to an Mahindra Authorised Dealer.
The lamp illuminates when Parking brake is When the EBD system is not functioning the vehicle could be unstable
engaged or when brake fluid level is low or during the hard braking. Therefore you must pay attention to the driving
conditions while this warning light.
3.20.7 Electric Parking Brake Malfunction (EPB) (If Following conditions indicate airbag malfunction:
equipped)
• Lamp fails to go OFF after engine is started
The EPB Lamp illuminates, when there is a • Lamp does not illuminate at all
malfunction in EBP. The lamp illuminates when
the ignition switch is turned ON and then goes • Illuminates while driving
off after about 4 seconds. Contact a Mahindra Authorised Dealer immediately when
the airbag warning lamp indicates a system malfunction.
The airbag may not deploy when needed, which could result
If the warning lamp is turned on, have the vehicle checked and serviced at in serious or fatal injury, or it might deploy unexpectedly or
a Mahindra Dealer or Authorised Mahindra Service Centre unnecessarily, which may result in personal injury.
If you must park the vehicle with faulty EPB, safely pull over and stop the
vehicle on a flat surface and shift the gear selector lever to the P position
3.20.10 HHC malfunction (if equipped)
3.20.8 Park Lamp HHC Malfunction Lamp comes on when the
ignition switch is turned ON and then goes off
The Park lamp indicator illuminates whenever after about 4 seconds. if there is any
park lamp is switched ON through malfunction in hill hold control system of the vehicle.
Combination switch. When ignition is switched
OFF and if park lamp is ON with driver door open, and alert
will be audible.
There are chances of vehicle rolling down when starting on a hill. No
assistance will be available from ESP system.
3.20.9 Airbag Warning Lamp If the warning lamp is turned on, have the vehicle checked and serviced at
a Mahindra Dealer or Authorised Mahindra Service Centre
If the lamp remains ON continuously or flash
intermittently, contact an Mahindra Authorised
Dealer immediately.
3.20.11 Door Ajar Warning Lamp 3.20.14 ESC System Warning Lamp (if equipped)
The door ajar warning lamp illuminates when While driving, if the ESC system warning lamp
any of the doors including the hood and back blinks, it indicates that ESC has taken control of
door are open during ignition ON. The buzzer the vehicle stability. If the lamp remains ON, it
chimes when the vehicle speed more than 2 kmph. The indicates the malfunction in the ESC System. Contact the
lamp and chime goes OFF when all the doors are closed nearest Mahindra Authorised Dealer.
properly.
3.20.12 Low Fuel Warning Lamp If the warning lamp is turned on, have the vehicle checked
and serviced at a Mahindra Dealer or Authorised Mahindra
When the fuel level in the fuel tank falls below Service Centre
the reserve limit, the low fuel warning lamp is
illuminated. Refuel sufficiently and the lamp 3.20.15 Front Fog Lamp (if equipped)
goes out. If the lamp continues to remain ON even after
refuelling, contact an Mahindra Authorised Dealer. The front fog lamp telltale indicates the status
of the front fog lamp. The front fog lamp can
3.20.13 ESC OFF Lamp (if equipped) be switched ON only when the parking lamp is
ON.
The ESC OFF lamp illuminates when the ESC
has been switched OFF manually.
Fog lamp will turn ON, if fitted in the vehicle.
This lamp comes on when the ignition switch is
turned ON and then goes off after about 4 seconds.
Pressing and holding the ESC OFF switch (for more than 3
seconds) turns on the indicator lamp indicating that the ESC
function is deactivated.
3.20.16 Engine Stop/Start Lamp (If equipped) 3.20.18 Seat Belt Warning Lamp
START The Engine Stop/Start lamp flashes when the The seat belt warning lamp illuminates and the
A vehicle/engine is about to stop through the buzzer chimes reminding the driver to fasten
STOP
Engine Stop/ Start System. The lamp the seat belt when the ignition is ON and
illuminates continuously when the vehicle/engine has been vehicle running condition. The lamp will continue to
switched OFF by the Engine Stop/Start System. On restarting illuminate till the driver fastens the seat belt properly.
the vehicle / engine again by using the clutch/key, the lamp
goes out.
3.20.19 DPF Indicator Lamp (If equipped)
3.20.17 Tiretronics (if equipped) If the DPF indicator is ON in the engine running
condition then DPF regeneration has not
SYSTEM MALFUNCTION : Tiretronics lamp Blink happened. Follow the instructions mentioned
for approx. 90 sec & then Continuous ON. in the “EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM”.
3.20.21 Glow Plug Indicator (If equipped) 3.20.24 OBD Check Lamp
Glow plug indicator illuminates when the The OBD check lamp illuminates when the
ignition is turned ON and Glow plug is ignition is switched ON and remains ON till the
activated. It automatically goes OFF when the engine is started indicating normal status. If
glow plug reaches the required temperature. Contact a the lamp remains ON, it indicates a potential malfunction.
Mahindra Authorised Dealer, if it illuminates while driving.
There may be a malfunction in:
3.20.26 Low Engine Oil Pressure Warning Lamp engine immediately. Contact the nearest Mahindra
Authorised Dealer for necessary repairs.
The low engine oil pressure warning lamp
illuminates when the ignition is switched ON
and goes OFF when the engine is started. If the 3.20.28 Battery Charging System Warning Lamp
lamp remains ON even after starting the engine, or
illuminates while driving, stop immediately, check the oil The battery charging system warning lamp
level after 2-3 minutes. If low, add engine oil to the “MAX” illuminates when the battery is not being
level and check status. If problem persists, contact an charged or when there is a malfunction in the
Mahindra Authorised Dealer immediately. alternator.
This lamp illuminates when the ignition is switched ON and
goes out as soon as the engine is started. If the lamp
Operating the vehicle with the low oil pressure warning continues to remain ON even after starting the engine, it is
lamp ON could cause sudden unexpected engine failure and an indication that the battery is not being charged or there
loss of vehicle control, resulting in an accident and/or is a malfunction in the alternator. Check the alternator drive
serious personal injury. belt for looseness/breakage. If the drive belt is okay, switch
OFF all unnecessary electrical equipment and recheck.
Contact a Mahindra Authorised Dealer for further
assistance.
Do not run the engine with low oil pressure warning
indicator ON. This may result in engine damage, which will
not be covered by the limited warranty. 3.20.29 High Engine Coolant Temperature Warning
Lamp
3.20.27 Check Engine Lamp The high engine coolant temperature warning
lamp flashes when the coolant temperature is
Indicating normal status. The lamp blinks or above 113ºC . It starts to flash when the
ENGINE ! illuminates continuously if there is a fault in the temperature reaches 113ºC and will be continuously ON
engine management system. Switch OFF the with buzzer alert when the temperature reaches 115ºC.
The bars in the temperature gauge also flash in the same • If the Indicator lamp is blinking continuously, reduce the
frequency as the high temperature warning lamp when the vehicle speed until the lamp stops blinking. Contact the
above set temperature thresholds are reached. Mahindra dealer as soon as possible.
When there is a problem with the system, do one of the Illuminates LKA system is in Active state
following::
• Check if the system is affected by the weather. (e. g. fog,
heavy rain, etc.) LKA system is in Not Working/Fail
Illuminates
state
• Check if there is foreign matter on the Front camera lens.
• If the problem is not solved, we recommend you to
contact an Mahindra Authorised Dealer for further
assistance. When there is a problem with the system, do one of the
following:
LDW System Warning Lamp with blinking:
• Check if the system is affected by the weather. (e. g. fog,
If the Front Camera (FCM) is not calibrated properly, means heavy rain, etc.)
this warning lamp blinks continuously. Contact a Mahindra
Authorised Dealer immediately. • Check if there is foreign matter on the Front camera lens.
• If the problem is not solved, we recommend you to The warning light illuminates When the radar/camera
contact an Mahindra Authorised Dealer for further sensor or cover is blocked with dirt /snow or if there is
assistance. permanent failure.
LKA System Warning Lamp with blinking: • Check the radar sensor and cover and clean them by
using a soft cloth.
If the Front Camera (FCM) is not calibrated properly, this
warning lamp blinks continuously. Contact a Mahindra • Check if there is foreign matter on the Front camera lens.
Authorised Dealer immediately.
• If the problem is not solved, we recommend you to
contact an Mahindra Authorised Dealer for further
3.20.35 Automatic Emergency Braking ON/OFF assistance.
Warning Lamp (if equipped)
The warning light illuminates on the LCD 3.20.37 High Beam Assist Lamp (if equipped)
AEBS
OFF display, when user turned OFF the AEB system.
The driver can monitor the AEB ON/OFF status This warning light illuminates when the driver
on the LCD display. If the warning light remains ON when sets HBA ON/OFF via cluster and Auto Light
the AEB is activated, we recommend you to have the system
AUTO Switch to ON and Head Lamp Switch to High.
checked by an Mahindra Authorised Dealer for further
assistance
• Check if the system is affected by the weather. (e. g. fog,
3.20.36 Automatic Emergency Braking Warning/ heavy rain, etc.)
Malfunction Lamp (if equipped) • Check if there is foreign matter on the Front camera lens.
This warning lamp Indicates temporary or If the problem is not solved, we recommend you to contact
permanent fault in Automatic Emergency an Mahindra Authorised Dealer for further assistance.
braking system.
3.20.38 Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) Warning If the problem is not solved, we recommend you to contact
Lamp (if equipped) an Mahindra Authorised Dealer for further assistance.
Indicates Adaptive cruise control system Indicates permanent failure of Adaptive cruise
temporarily not available due to temporary control system. Contact a Mahindra Authorised
abnormal condition. Dealer immediately.
The warning light illuminates When the radar/camera SPA system is in Not Working/Fail
sensor or cover is blocked with dirt or snow. Illuminates
state
• Check the radar sensor and cover and clean them by
using a soft cloth.
• Check if there is foreign matter on the Front camera lens.
3.20.40 All Wheel Drive Malfunction (AWD) (If • When the AUTO HOLD switch is operated, the AUTO
equipped) HOLD system will be switched to READY mode and the
"AUTO HOLD" indicator on the instrument cluster will be
The warning light illuminates on the display illuminated in white.
when AWD system is in Malfunction
• Operating the AUTO HOLD switch again turns off the
indicator and deactivates the AUTO HOLD system.
3.20.41 Auto Vehicle Hold (AVH) (If equipped)
The AVH Lamp illuminates, there is a malfunction in AVH. If the yellow AUTO HOLD warning lamp is turned on, have
the vehicle checked and serviced at a Mahindra Dealer or
Authorised Mahindra Service Centre
4 EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM In addition, it is important to use the correct grade of fuel,
confirming IS 2796:2017 BS VI specification.
Your Vehicle is equipped with an emission control system to
meet all applicable emission regulations. Three-Way Catalytic Converter (TWC)
There are three emission control system which are as It is an exhaust after treatment component that is designed
follows. to convert carbon monoxide (CO), hydrocarbons (HC),
nitrogen oxides (NOx) into carbon dioxide (CO2), nitrogen
1. Crankcase emission control system (N) and water (H2O).
2. Evaporative emission control system Emission Control System for Diesel vehicles
3. Exhaust emission control system The emission control system is a highly effective system
To ensure optimal functioning of the emission control which controls exhaust emissions from the engine and
systems, it is recommended that you have your vehicle crucial for meeting emission norms specified by law.
inspected and maintained by an authorised Mahindra Your vehicle is equipped with the following emission control
dealer. systems for meeting BS VI emission norms.
Emission Control Systems for Petrol vehicles 1. Diesel Oxidation Catalyst (DOC)
4.1 Diesel Oxidation Catalyst (DOC) MaxiCLEAN DEF is available at all the Authorised Mahindra
Dealers in packs of variable capacities. Individual DEF Packs
A diesel oxidation catalyst (DOC) is an after-treatment may have specific filler neck, for filling DEF in the vehicle.
component that is designed to convert carbon monoxide While refilling DEF, take care to avoid spillage on your body
(CO) and hydrocarbons (HC) into carbon dioxide (CO2) and or outer panels of the vehicle to avoid any stains or
water (H2O). inconvenience.
• DEF quality and purity can be ensured only if it is stored authorized M&M dealer to determine the appropriate repair
as per recommendations. Hence ensure to store DEF in a procedure.
cool, dry place.
Handling of DEF
• Do not add urea to DEF and do not dilute with water.
This may cause damage to the after treatment system. • Ensure that DEF does not come into contact with skin,
eyes, or clothing
• While refilling DEF be careful not to allow any foreign
particles, liquids, wiping paper/clothing fibers or lint to • Keep DEF out of the reach of children
get inside the system. These may clog or damage the • In case if any part of the body comes in contact with DEF,
system. clean affected area immediately with plenty of water
• While refilling DEF, use only the pipe supplied with the • If DEF comes in contact with eyes, flush with plenty of
MaxiCLEAN. Do not use any funnel or container. Any water immediately and seek medical help.
contamination with Diesel or oils will cause malfunction
of the after treatment system. • If DEF is swallowed, rinse mouth immediately with plenty
of water, drink plenty of water immediately and seek
• If DEF accidently spill over vehicle components or metal medical help.
surfaces, rinse with water or wipe off with sponge and
water. DEF residues will corrode the components, metal • Refrain from storing DEF refill containers inside the
surfaces and painted body panels. vehicle. Ammonia vapors may escape from the container
which have a pungent odor and are particularly irritating
• DEF is not a fuel additive and must not be added to the to the skin, mucous membranes and eyes. Inhaling
diesel fuel tank. If DEF is mixed with the diesel fuel, ammonia vapors may cause irritation to the eyes, nose
engine/fuel system could get damaged. and throat, as well as cough.
• In such a case, do not start the engine and immediately • When opening the DEF filler cap, ammonia vapors may
contact nearest Mahindra Authorised Dealer for escape. Therefore ensure to refill DEF in a well- ventilated
assistance. area only.
Contamination/ Incorrect DEF: If incorrect or
contaminated fluid is filled inside DEF Tank, contact an
If the DEF warning lamp turns on due to the DEF level, refill
the DEF tank. Failure to refill may cause engine start
restriction.
If SCR system detects any malfunction due to failures in The Diesel particulate filter (DPF) is an integral part of the
components or tampering, warnings are flashed in stages as vehicle exhaust gas emission reduction systems and it removes
explained below: the soot (Particulate matter) from the exhaust gas. Unlike a
disposable air filter, the DPF is a regenerative filter.
Regeneration is triggered automatically according to vehicle
E21 E22 E23 driving conditions which burns the accumulated particles/soot
from the DPF. The process is called as DPF Active
Regeneration.
However, if the vehicle continues to be driven in the below
conditions the accumulated soot may not be automatically
removed because of low exhaust gas temperatures.
If the DPF telltale turns ON when driving the vehicle, it DPF Park Regeneration
indicates that the DPF regeneration has not occurred
successfully. At this moment, we suggest DPF regeneration DPF park regeneration is the procedure to start a DPF
must be done as mentioned below: regeneration when the vehicle is stationary from the
instrument cluster. Follow the below steps to perform Park
Take the vehicle to an empty stretch of road/highway and Regeneration. The DPF park regeneration is only possible
drive for 20 – 30 mins @ speeds above 60 km/hr until the when the REGEN telltale is ON in the instrument cluster.
telltale turns off.
• Park the vehicle safely in a well ventilated levelled open
space and free of any flammable material.
• Follow speed limits & traffic regulations as defined by • Shift the gear lever to Neutral with the engine running
local jurisdiction while driving. and apply the parking brake.
If the DPF telltale starts blinking, perform DPF park • Access the Drive info menu in the instrument cluster and
regeneration following the below procedure. press the down button to go to the REGEN screen, REGEN
screen will appear only when the REGEN telltale is ON.
If the OBD telltale is ON & DPF telltale blinking. Stop the
vehicle and contact the nearest Authorised Mahindra dealer
for assistance.
E F 5 C H
ZIP
A B C C A B
A B C
(and) REGEN
DEF Indicator Lamp DPF Indicator Lamp REGEN Indicator Lamp OBD Check Lamp
For other regional languages, Kindly refer the Annexure chapter at the end of this manual.
(and) REGEN
DPF Indicator Lamp REGEN Indicator Lamp Error Code Alert Message in Cluster Action to Taken
E31 DEF LEVEL LOW ENGINE WILL NOT START IN 2400 KM Fill DEF within 2400 km
E32/E33 DEF LEVEL LOW, ENGINE WILL NOT START IN 800 KM /...KM Fill DEF within 800 km
DEF Indicator Lamp OBD Check Lamp
E34 NO RESTART ALLOWED, FILL DEF Fill DEF immediately
E35
NO START ALLOWED, FILL DEF Fill DEF immediately
Warning Lamp Engine Action
Indicates
Status Peformance to be taken E11 INCORRECT DEF, DETECTED / WRONG DEF, DETECTED Refill with Correct DEF
1. Go to the highway and drive
ON DPF is
above 60 kms/hr for 20-30 min
E12/E13 INCORRECT DEF, ENGINE WILL NOT START IN 800 KM /...KM / Refill with Correct DEF
(or)
Normal starting 2. Perform Park Regeneration
WRONG DEF ENGINE WILL NOT START IN 800 KM /...KM
to choke (or) E14 NO RESTART ALLOWED, CHECK DEF Refill with Correct DEF
REGEN ON 3. Take the vehicle to Mahindra
Authorized Dealer
E15 NO START ALLOWED, CHECK DEF Refill with Correct DEF
Limp DPF almost Perform Park Regeneration
Blinking (or)
home fully choked
DEF DOSING MALFUNCTIONING Contact Mahindra Dealer
Take the vehicle to Mahindra E21
ON
REGEN Authorized Dealer
E22/E23
DEF DOSING MALFUNCTIONING,ENGINE WILL NOT START IN 800 KM /
Contact Mahindra Dealer
DEF DOSING MALFUNCTIONING,ENGINE WILL NOT START IN ... KM
Blinking E24 NO RESTART ALLOWED , DOSING MALFUNCTIONING Contact Mahindra Dealer
Limp DPF Take the vehicle to Mahindra
home fully choked
Authorized Dealer
ON E25 NO START ALLOWED , DOSING MALFUNCTIONING Contact Mahindra Dealer
Do's & Don’ts • Do not refill the DEF with Engine ON or ignition ON state
Selective Catalytic Reduction (SCR) • When opening the DEF filler cap, ammonia vapors may
escape. Refill DEF in a well - ventilated area only.
• Diesel Exhaust Fluid (DEF) complying to IS 17042 (or) ISO
22241 specification can be used. • Ensure that DEF does not come into contact with skin,
eyes, or clothing
• Never attempt to use agricultural grade urea mixed with
water. Agricultural grade urea does not meet the Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF)
necessary specifications and the after-treatment system
of your vehicle may be damaged. During the regeneration process, ensure not to park the
vehicle near any flammable materials as you may observe
• Do not add urea to DEF and do not dilute with water. This hot emission gases from exhaust pipe.
may cause damage to the treatment system.
To avoid burns & personal injury, keep yourself away from
• Total DEF quantity inside the DEF tank should never exhaust system.
exceed 20 liters. Overfilling may result in system/
component failure. Follow speed limits & traffic regulations as defined by local
jurisdiction while driving.
• While refilling DEF inside tank be careful not to allow any
foreign particles, liquids, wiping paper/clothing fibers or
lint to get inside the system. These may clog or damage
the system.
• DEF is not a fuel additive and must not be added to the
diesel fuel tank. If DEF is mixed with the diesel fuel,
engine/fuel system could get damaged
• If DEF is spilled over vehicle components and metal
surfaces, rinse with water or wipe off with sponge and
water. DEF residues will corrode the components and
metal surfaces, painted body panels
XXXX
operate all locks in your
vehicle including those of the
doors and ignition with
X
steering lock.
X
X
X
U82G08
5.1.4 Manual Locking/Unlocking Doors from For unlocking insert the key and rotate it in clockwise gently (don’t
Outside (Mechanical Handle) apply abusive load). Take out the key to return the handle to
nominal position and pull back the handle to open the door.
For locking, Pull the handle and same time press the door with
Push the handle slightly as knee so that door is not getting unlatched (as handle goes to
release mode) insert the key and rotate the key anti-clockwise
shown in the image.
gently. Take out the key and leave the handle to nominal position.
Pull the handle once to ensure locking happen properly.
2. Slide the mechanical key to the left side and hold the
Then press the tail gate key in the same position to open the tail gate.
release switch on the
bottom of the tailgate 5.2 Central Locking System
within 45 second as shown
in the illustration and pull All doors of the vehicle can be simultaneously locked or
tailgate to open. unlocked from the driver door.
To close the tailgate, lower the tailgate half way down and 5.2.1 Central Locking/Unlocking All Doors from
allow it fall on its own weight. The door will be locked Outside
automatically.
To manually lock/unlock all the doors from outside using
the conventional key, turn the key anti-clockwise /clockwise
5.1.7 Tailgate Safety Release Lever respectively in the driver door keyhole.
5.2.2 Central Locking/Unlocking All Doors from 5.2.3 Child Safety Rear Door lock (If equipped)
Inside
Your vehicle is equipped with left and right-side child safety
rear door locks. When the lock mechanism is engaged, the
A B Press the driver door lock
rear door(s) cannot be opened from the inside. The door(s)
tab down (A) to lock or lift
can only be opened from the outside.
the lock tab up (B) to unlock
To activate the child safety right rear door lock, push the
all doors simultaneously.
lever down (A) till you hear a distinct click indicating the
activation of the child lock.
Anti-Lock Out To de-activate the child safety right rear door lock, pull the
lever up (B) till you hear a distinct click indicating the
Master Actuator Lock at Door open (Except Driver Door)
deactivation of the child lock.
— If any door is opened and driver door is in closed
condition:
• Vehicle speed is below 7 kmph - On actuating master A
actuator lock manually, master actuator will get lock &
unlock immediately for the first time. On actuating A: Activate/Lock
master actuator lock again, vehicle will get locked. B:De-activate/Unlock
B
• Vehicle speed above 7 kmph - On actuating master
actuator lock manually, vehicle will get locked for the first
time itself.
If driver door is open and master actuator lock is If the rear doors are not operable from inside, ensure that
performed, vehicle will not get locked the child safety locks have been disabled.
Mahindra strongly recommends that the child safety rear
door locks be used whenever there are children travelling in
the rear seat.
5.3 Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System 5.3.3 To Lock and Arm the Vehicle with RKE
A
A: LED
Press the LOCK button on
B
B B: Lock the RKE key fob for locking
C
C
C: Tailgate Release / Search and arming the vehicle.
D
D
D: Unlock
W62G95
Hazard lamps flash once - if all the doors in the vehicle are
5.3.1 Precautions while Handling Remote Key locked and armed successfully using RKE.
Hazard lamps flash five times along with an alarm - if
• Do not cover the key grip with any material that cuts off
any of the doors (including bonnet) in the vehicle are open.
RF signal
• Do not leave the key exposed to high temperatures for a
long period, such as on the dashboard or bonnet under
If alarm is in mute condition only the Hazard lamps will
direct sunlight
flash. If alarm to be activated then Press Lock & Unlock
• Do not put the key in any liquid or wash it in an ultrasonic button together to unmute the alarm. Now both Hazard
washer lamps flash and alarm will work.
5.3.4 Unlock and Disarm the Vehicle with RKE • All doors are closed properly
• Vehicle speed is greater than 7 kmph
Auto Locking ON DOOR OPEN — Once the auto lock has
Press the UNLOCK button been activated, if any door is opened, then the auto lock will
on the RKE key fob to reactivate only if all doors are closed, the vehicle speed goes
unlock and disarm the below 5 kmph and further crosses 7 kmph
vehicle.
Auto Locking ON MASTER ACTUATOR UNLOCK — Once
the auto lock has been activated, if any door is opened, then
the auto lock will reactivate only if all doors are closed, the
vehicle speed goes below 5 kmph and further crosses 7
Hazard lamps flash twice - if there was no theft attempt kmph
during the lock (armed) period.
Front DRL & Tail lamps flash twice (If equipped)- if there 5.3.6 Auto Unlocking
was no theft attempt during the lock (armed) period.
Auto Unlock of all doors will happen in the following
Hazard lamps flash four times along with an alarm - if
conditions:
there was a theft attempt during the lock (armed) period.
• When Ignition is switched from ON to OFF, OR In the
event of a crash
Upon the remote lock, if any of the doors are not closed
properly or left open, the hazard lamps will flash five times 5.3.7 Auto Re-locking
to indicate the same.
Auto Re-lock of all doors will happen when;
5.3.5 Auto Locking • No door status change for 45 seconds after unlocking the
vehicle using RKE/PKE
All doors will get locked automatically when;
Passive Keyless Entry (PKE) System enables you to enter or • While locking and unlocking the vehicle Passively, the
exit your vehicle without the need to manually lock/unlock distance between the Smart Key and the corresponding
the doors. You can start/stop, lock or unlock the vehicle door handle must not be greater than 3ft (1m).
using PKE. To do this, you only need carry the PKE key fob
with you. • Do not cover the key grip with any material that cuts off
RF waves
• Do not leave the key exposed to high temperatures for a
A long period, such as on the dashboard or bonnet under
A: LED direct sunlight
B
B
B: Lock
• Do not put the key in any liquid or wash it in an
C
C
C: Tailgate Release / Search ultrasonic washer
D
D
D: Unlock • The PKE can malfunction if exposed to moisture or static
W62G95
electricity
Carrying the PKE along with you, you can lock or unlock the
The front side of the PKE key fob has three control buttons: doors and tail door and even start and stop the engine
Unlock (D), Lock (B) and Tail gate release (C) buttons. There without inserting the key. Functions of the buttons on a PKE
is also a emergency key release button, which releases a is similar to the remote keyless entry.
mechanical key for emergency purposes (E. g. when PKE
battery is low). To remove the metal key, press and hold the Locking the vehicle – Through Flush Handle (Electrical
release button and pull the mechanical key out. Handle)
1. Carry the PKE
2. Close all the doors
• Key should be in the proximity of less than 0.7 m from • On performing PKE passive lock with key fob in your
the outside door handle possession in ignition ON state, "Key Not in Vehicle" alert
will be triggered in cluster along with chirp & hazard
• Vehicle can be locked centrally by pressing the door lamps flash for 5 times and vehicle will remain in unlock
handle with the PKE key fob in the proximity (PKE key fob state.
should be nearer to the triggered side). For E.g., locking/
unlocking of the driver door is possible only if PKE is • On performing key fob remote lock with all doors closed
around the driver area in ignition ON state, no alert will be triggered and vehicle
will remain in unlock state.
• Even after pressing the outside door handle button, if the
Unlocking the vehicle:
doors do not lock, a chime is heard along with the
hazard blinking for 5 times, then one of the following 1. Carry the PKE Key fob
situations are possible reason:
2. Press the button in the door handle
– PKE Key fob is left inside the vehicle
3. All doors would unlock and Front DRL & Tail lamps
– One of the doors not closed properly flash twice.
• Key should be in the proximity of less than 0.7 m from • Key should be in the proximity of less than 0.7 m from
the outside driver door handle the outside door handle
• Vehicle can be unlocked centrally by pressing the door • Tail door can be unlocked by pressing the button in the
handle only when the key is in same side of the driver tail door only when the key is in range from the tail door
door handle is pressed
Unlocking the Tail door alone: 5.4.1 Engine START/STOP Switch (SSS) (if equipped)
1. Carry the PKE Key Fob
VOL +
The engine can be started SET+
ENT
RESUME
REAR
3. Tail door would unlock and hazard warning lights will A/C ECON
A/C
Whenever the doors are opened or the door handle button
blink 3 times is pressed, the engine start/stop button will be illuminated
and will go off after few seconds.
4. On closing the door, tail door would get locked NO OFF
automatically
USB
button will turn red to indicate the IGN ON position and the
vehicle is ready for starting. . If the steering wheel
doesn’t unlock properly,
press the start/stop
OFF ACC ON button while turning the
steering wheel right/left to
VOL + VOL +
SET+
ENTER
VOL +
SET+
ENTER
SET+
ENTER
release the tension on the
lock.
SET- SET- SET-
3 3 3
2 2 2
Still if you are not able to turn ON the IGN, please contact
1 1 1
Key fob.
USB
remaining ON) without engine running, can drain the
USB USB
Starting the vehicle turning off and loss of power assist for the steering and brake
systems. This may lead to loss of direction control and braking
Manual Transmission: To start the engine, press the clutch function, leading to an accident.
and press the engine start/stop button once with the key
Even if the key fob is not there in the cabin. The engine will keep
inside the vehicle. The engine can be started from any running, until it is switched off, after that it can not be
position (OFF / ACC / ON) of the start/stop switch. restarted in absence of the key Before leaving the driver seat,
Automatic Transmission: To start the engine, Gear Lever always make sure engine start/stop switch is in OFF position
and always take the PKE Key Fob with you. If the Ignition
shall be in Park Position, press the Brake pedal and press
remains ON and the doors are locked. The central locking
the engine start/stop button once with the key inside the
system will give 3 chirps and flashes to indicate. This can cause
vehicle. The engine can be started from any position (OFF / battery to be drained off.
ACC / ON) of the start/stop switch.
As a emergency procedure (if any failure of brake or clutch
switch). If the SSS is pressed continuously for more than 10
seconds then the engine can be started.
Ensure the gear lever is in neutral/Park position before
starting. Emergency stop: To turn the engine OFF in an emergency,
press and hold the engine start/stop button for more than 2
seconds or rapidly press and release the engine start/stop
button 3 times within 3 seconds. On doing so, the vehicle
If engine start/stop switch is pressed without pressing the ignition is changed to ACC position.
clutch (MT) / Brake (AT) pedal, engine will not start, and the
vehicle power modes will change as follows: OFF→ ON →OFF→ BACK up Start: If the key fob battery is low, the key may not
ON be detected on pressing SSS and SSS LED will be blinking in
If the engine start/stop switch is pressed from the OFF position red color. In such a situation, press the start/stop button
directly, along with the clutch (MT) / Brake (AT) in depressed once while the status LED in the button is blinking Red and
position, there may be a small delay in the engine cranking. the below error message is displayed in the instrument
This is normal and is not a fault. cluster.
Never press the engine start/stop switch while the vehicle is in
motion except in an emergency. This will result in the engine
On pressing the Start/Stop switch 1st time with the key fob Key fob battery low can be detected only if the key has been
in the key fob tray below the armrest. The Start-stop switch continuously used in the vehicle. Keeping the key outside the
LED will blink in red color, with the above error message will vehicle for longer duration and then using it with the
be displayed again in the cluster. In this case, if you press drained battery cannot be detected.
the Start/Stop switch again vehicle will start in Back-Up
mode, if the Clutch(MT)/Brake(AT) pedal is pressed.
Back-up Mode : When the key fob battery is critically low to
detect the key fob inside the vehicle or the battery is dead
or not available. This mode is triggered by the PKE to
understand the condition to Switch ON ignition and to start
the vehicle engine.
5.4.2 Vehicle locking/Unlocking in an Emergency jacket pocket or in the bag and maintain adequate
Situation distance between the two devices
If the PKE Key Fob does not operate normally, you can lock • Another vehicle PKE key fob is being operated close to
your vehicle
or unlock the doors by using the mechanical key:
• PKE Key Fob kept inside the glove box or top bin in the
instrument panel may not be detected sometimes. Keep
Refer to Manual Locking/Unlocking Doors from Outside the PKE Key Fob in the visible zone or in your pocket for
(Mechanical/Electrical Handle) section for more details. getting it detected
It is strictly not advisable to leave the key fobs in the vehicle. • Keep the PKE key fob away from the water or any liquid.
Vehicle can be started by any unauthorised person. If the keyless entry system is inoperative due to exposure
to water or liquids, it will not be covered by your
A maximum of 2 Keys can be registered to a vehicle. If you lose manufacturer’s vehicle warranty
a key, we strictly recommend to contact Mahindra Authorised
Dealer immediately to block the lost key and to get a new key.
The PKE Key Fob may not work if any of the following Make sure the vehicle ignition is in OFF state, whenever
occurs: leaving the vehicle even with the key. By keeping the vehicle
ignition in ON/ACC state will hamper the vehicle security.
• If the vehicle is close to a radio station, airport, or an area
where there is a possibility of large radio transmissions Do not hand over the PKE Key Fob to any unauthorized
which can interfere with the normal operation of the person or service provider. Your vehicle security system may
PKE/RKE be compromised in doing so.
5.5 Remote Battery the positive side of the batteries face up. Align both the
halves of the Remote casing and press to snap fit. Check
Battery Specification operation of the Remote.
Battery Voltage 3V
Battery Capacity 225 mAh While prying the Remote case, take care not to damage the
Battery Model No. battery.
2032
Do not touch the battery terminals that are on the back
Remote Battery Replacement housing or the printed circuit board.
If the Remote operation is inconsistent when any of the Pull out the battery and discard the same. Insert new
buttons are pressed, then it indicates that the Remote battery of same type. While fitting the new battery, ensure
battery is weak. the positive side of the batteries face up. Align both the
halves of the Remote casing and press to snap fit. Check
operation of the Remote.
The Batteries are Lithium Ion batteries. They should be kept
+
CR 2032
The rear side of the Remote away from children.
3V
3V
20
CR
+
battery cover. hours and lead to death.
Keep new or removed batteries away from children. If the battery
`
compartment does not close securely, discontinue use and keep
Use a small flat head screwdriver to gently pry out the away from children. If you think that batteries have been
swallowed or stuck in any part of the body, seek medical help
battery to and discard the same. Insert new batteries of 3V immediately.
type (Battery No. 2032). While fitting the new battery, ensure
5.6 Key Fob Tray LED will blink in red color, with the above error message will
be displayed again in the cluster.
In this case, if you press the Start/Stop switch again before
the above error message in the instrument cluster goes
away the 2nd time, the vehicle will start in Back-Up mode, if
the Clutch(MT)/Brake(AT) pedal is pressed.
or stolen key. This is essential to avoid unauthorised access the correct coded key. When a wrong key is inserted or a
using the misplaced key. theft attempt is detected, the alarm is set off, and the
Only PKE/RKE transmitters programmed to your vehicle hazard lamps flash along with a siren.
electronics can be used for remote locking and unlocking of The system is automatically activated when the key is
your vehicle. removed from the ignition.
5.9 Engine Immobiliser System If the engine check lamp flashes or remains continuously
illuminated after the ignition being switched ON, there is a
An Engine Immobiliser System is a security system that system malfunction. Contact an Mahindra Authorised
prevents the vehicle from being operated by an Dealer immediately.
unauthorised person. The Engine immobiliser prevents the
engine from being started unless it recognizes signals from
With the correct coded key in the vehicle and pressing the 5.10 Opening and Closing the Bonnet
SSS ON, automatically recognizes and authenticates the
system. It enables the engine to start. The bonnet release lever is in the driver side foot well area,
below the instrument panel. To open bonnet follow the
VOL +
steps below:
SET+
SET-
ENTER
RESUME
In the event of the vehicle not starting with the correct key, START
ENGINE
STOP
3
2
RESUME
START
ENGINE
STOP
NO OFF
REAR
A/C ECON
A/C
`
The security system will be activated when the vehicle is locked
using the PKE/RKE key fob. Locking the doors with the manual key
will also activate the security system.
Using the ignition key blade to open the diver door, when the
vehicle was locked and armed with PKE/RKE key fob, in this
condition if any of the door is opened which results in door switch
status change will be treated as unauthorised by the system setting
and this will trigger the alarm. Press the unlock button on the PKE/
RKE key fob to off the alarm.
2. Lift the bonnet a little to 1. Remove the stay rod supporting the bonnet by slightly
access the safety latch lifting the bonnet
holding the bonnet striker. 2. Bring the bonnet near to its self-opening/closing
This safety latch is located position
below the bonnet at the
center. 3. Now, push the bonnet to close and ensure the
primary latch is engaged
`
4. Before driving off, check bonnet is locked properly
with primary latch fully engaged
`
Diesel should be filled in Petrol should be filled in
diesel filler cap. petrol filler cap.
`
3. Then press the fuel lid gently once to open.
1. Release the parking brake / EPB (Electric Parking For smooth functioning and reliable operation of the engine
Brake) during cold weather conditions, use suitable fuel (Petrol/Diesel)
which will be available at filling stations during winter months.
2. Depress the clutch Check with your fuel retailer for details.
3. Shift the gear lever to 1st gear Coolant in the radiator will survive up to ambient
temperature of -15 degree C. If the ambient temperature is
4. Release the brake pedal
expected go below -15 degree C, during operation, the • Engage the parking brake / EPB
engine will require a different coolant/coolant
concentration. Contact a Mahindra Authorised Dealer for • Move the gear shift lever to 1st gear position (reverse
assistance. gear if parking on an incline).
• Slowly release the brake pedal
6.3 Stopping the Engine • Lock your vehicle when leaving
Your vehicle is powered by a turbo engine. Before turning the Automatic Transmission
engine OFF, always allow the engine to return to normal idle
speed and run for few seconds. This assures proper cooling • Keep your right foot on the service brake pedal
and lubrication of the turbocharger. This is particularly • Turn front wheels towards the road curb
necessary after any hard driving.
• Engage the parking brake / EPB
• Shift the gear lever to Park “P” position
To reduce the risk of personal injury, before turning OFF the
engine and leaving the vehicle, always follow the below • Switch OFF the ignition, turn the key to the steering lock
mentioned safety tips. position and remove the key
Manual Transmission-MT • Press the start stop button once to switch off the vehicle
(for PKE only)
• Keep your right foot on the brake pedal
• Slowly release the brake pedal
• Turn front wheels towards the road curb
• Lock your vehicle when leaving
• Switch OFF the ignition, turn the key to the steering lock
position and remove the key
• Press the start stop button once to switch off the vehicle Alert will be displayed in the infotainment screen if the gear
(for PKE only) shifter is not in P position. Engine will not switch off unless
shifter is in P position.
Protection against exhaust gas entry into the vehicles Never keep the engine running when the vehicle is parked in
interior is considered in the design of the exhaust system. an area which is not properly ventilated. This could lead to
serious respiratory problems and/or death
• Vehicle exhaust contains Carbon Monoxide, Carbon
Dioxide, Nitrogen Oxides, Hydrocarbons and Particulate
Matter. These are potential environmental and health 6.5 Driving Your Vehicle
hazards
6.5.1 Pedals
• Avoid inhaling the exhaust gases. Carbon Monoxide is a
colorless and odorless gas and can cause MT AT
unconsciousness or even death
• If the exhaust system is damaged for any reason or you
notice a change in the exhaust noise, have the vehicle
checked by an Mahindra Authorised Dealer immediately
• Do not start the vehicle in a closed garage or in an
enclosed area where ventilation is poor for the exhaust
C B A
gases B A
W62K34
• Since the engine compartment and exhaust system
components are hot and can ignite a fire, do not park or
A: Accelerator Pedal B: Brake Pedal C: Clutch Pedal
leave the vehicle with the engine idling over dry grass,
leaves, paper, rags or any combustible material
6.5.2 General Driving Precautions • Always drive at a safe speed appropriate for given driving
conditions. You must follow the speed limits
• While backing up, keep a constant lookout for people,
Always observe the following precautions to minimize the particularly children, or other obstructions or hazardous
risk of accidents leading to serious personal injury or material that might be present behind the vehicle
damage to your vehicle. • Avoid loading any items on the roof that will raise the
• Before you drive your vehicle, please read this manual vehicles center of gravity and make your vehicle more
carefully unstable
• Before you start driving, check proper operation of the • Loaded vehicles, with a higher center of gravity, may
brakes and steering system handle differently than unloaded vehicles. Extra
precautions, such as slower speeds and increased
• If, while driving, you hear any strange noise or feel stopping distance, should be taken when driving a heavily
unusual vibration, or if you have any concerns loaded vehicle
whatsoever, or if any warning lamps illuminate or
buzzers sound, park/stop the vehicle in a safe location as • Always slowdown in gusty crosswinds. Because of its
soon as possible. Identify the cause and take any profile and higher center of gravity, your vehicle is more
necessary remedial action. Contact your Mahindra sensitive to side winds than an ordinary passenger car.
Authorised Dealer if necessary Slowing down will allow you to have much better control
• Never overload or improperly load your vehicle • When driving in off-road or on rugged terrain, do not
drive at excessive speeds, jump, make sharp turns, strike
• Always be attentive while driving and follow safe driving objects, etc. This may cause loss of control or vehicle
practices rollover causing serious injury. You are also risking
expensive damage to your vehicle's suspension and
• Always maintain the recommended inflation pressure in chassis
tyres
• Maintain steering wheel control at all times, especially on
rough terrains. Sudden changes in terrain can result in
abrupt steering wheel motion. Make sure you grip the risk of loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover and/or
steering wheel from the outside. Do not grip the spokes personal injury. Use all available road surfaces to return
the vehicle to a safe direction of travel
• If the vehicle goes from one type of surface to another (e.
g. from concrete to gravel/sand/mud/snow) there will be
a change in the way the vehicle responds, especially the 6.5.3 Off-Road Driving Precautions
way it responds to steering, braking and accelerating
inputs • When driving in off-road or on rugged terrains, never
over speed or make sharp turns. This may cause loss of
• Be extremely careful when driving on pavements made control or vehicle rollover causing serious injury
slippery by loose sand, water, gravel, snow or ice
• Always maintain steering wheel control, Sudden changes
• If your vehicle goes off the edge of the pavement, slow in terrain can result in abrupt steering wheel motion
down, but avoid severe brake or steering application.
Ease the vehicle back onto the pavement only after • Drive cautiously to avoid vehicle damage from concealed
reducing your speed. Do not turn the steering wheel too objects such as rocks and stumps. You should either
sharply while returning to the road surface know the terrain or map-out your route before driving in
the area
• It may be safer to stay on the apron or shoulder of the
road and slow down gradually before returning to the • Always perform a maintenance inspection after each day
pavement. You may lose control if you do not slow down of off-road driving that has taken you through rough
or if you turn the steering wheel too sharply or abruptly terrain, sand, mud or water
• In an unavoidable emergency situation where a sudden
sharp turn must be made, turn the steering wheel only as
rapidly and as far as required to avoid the emergency.
Excessive steering will result in less vehicle control.
Additionally, smooth variations of the accelerator and/or
brake pedal pressure should be utilized if changes in
vehicle speed are called for. Avoid abrupt steering,
acceleration or braking which could result in an increased
6.5.4 If your vehicle is submerged • Wet brake discs have a lower coefficient or friction
resulting in reduced braking efficiency. Tab the brake
If Your stationary Vehicle is Submerged up to over the bumper pedal while driving to remove the film of water
• The ground under the water might not be firm which inspection after each day of off-road driving that has
could result the water being deeper than expected when taken you through water
driving the vehicle through it
• Do not stop or shut OFF the engine while immersed in 6.5.6 Flowing Water
water. It helps in preventing water getting inside the
exhaust pipes If the water is swift flowing and rising (as in storm run-off)
avoid crossing until the water level recedes and/or the flow
• When backing down a ramp, do not allow the exhaust tail rate is reduced. The flowing water can erode the streambed
pipe to immerse in water causing your vehicle to sink into deeper water. Determine
• Water can wash the grease from wheel bearings, causing the exit point(s) that are downstream of your entry point to
rusting and premature failure. It may also enter the compensate for drifting.
differentials, transmission, and transfer case, reducing
the oil's lubricating qualities. If these are submerged in 6.5.7 After Driving Off-Road or through Water
water, the lubricants should be replaced as required
• Water entering the transmission will cause deterioration Off-road operation puts more stress on your vehicle than
in shift quality, locking up of your transmission does most on-road driving. Always perform a maintenance
accompanied by vibration, and ultimately damaging the inspection after each day of off-road driving that has taken
transmission you through rough terrain, sand, mud, or water.
• Sand, mud/sludge that has accumulated in around brake • After going off-road, it is always a good idea to check for
discs may affect braking efficiency. This may also damage damage. Completely inspect the underbody of the
brake system components. Wet brakes cannot stop the vehicle for any damages
vehicle as effectively as dry brakes. Drying can be • Check for accumulations of plants or bushes. or
improved by driving the vehicle slowly while applying polyethylene / plastic. These could be a fire hazard at
light pressure on the brake pedal high temperatures.
• When driving through water, traction or brake capability • Inspect all the tubes/hoses and check for any fluid
may be limited. Always perform a maintenance leakages
• Get heat exchangers (radiator and condenser) cleaned 6.6 Tips for Better Fuel Economy
• We also recommend that the vehicle be checked at the Fuel mileage (efficiency) depends on the average speed of the
Mahindra Authorised Dealer for any water entry into the vehicle, number of times the gears are shifted/Clutch pressed and
transmission / axle or the engine. number of times the brakes are applied. Vehicles operating in city
traffic condition /bumper to bumper traffic will exhibit lower fuel
mileage as compared to vehicles operating in open highways with
higher average speeds.
Abrasive material in any part of the brakes may cause
excessive wear or unpredictable braking. You might not have DOs
full braking power when needed leading to accidents. If you
have been operating the vehicle in off-road conditions, get the • Ensure that your vehicle is maintained as per
brakes checked and cleaned as necessary. recommendation (Refer to Warranty and Service
Information Guide)
• If any unusual vibration is experienced, check the wheels for
impacted material. Impacted material can cause a wheel • Ensure that the tyre pressures are as per
imbalance. Get it inspected/corrected as soon as possible recommendation (Ref to sticker on door pillar or
Page 6-56 or Warranty and Service Information Guide)
• After driving through deep water, inspect your vehicle fluids
and lubricants (engine oil, transmission/transfer case/axle • Ensure parking brakes are released fully
oils) to ensure the fluids have not been contaminated
• Use Engine Start-Stop feature to the maximum
(Ref Page no 6-29), if applicable
• Drive with all the windows closed to reduce aerodynamic
drag
• Accelerate smoothly with a light foot on the accelerator
• Anticipate stops and slow down in coasting mode before Managing the Air conditioner for optimum fuel
applying brake efficiency
• In manual transmission, shift gears at the right speeds Recommended AC modes for obtaining optimum fuel
(Ref page 6-15 for gear shift indication prompts) efficiency.
Don'ts
MX/AX3/AX5 AX7/AX7L
• Fitting roof carrier will increase drag and reduce fuel
mileage
• Driving at speeds above 80 Kms/hr reduces fuel mileage
• Do not rest the left foot on the clutch pedal in manual
transmission vehicles as it will reduce the fuel mileage as
well as damage clutch/transmission components
How to Measure /Read Fuel Mileage Values?
• Do not attempt to use brakes with the left foot in
Automatic transmission vehicles • The Fuel mileage value is displayed in the cluster as AFE
(Average Fuel Economy) in Kms/lit.
• The AFE can be set to multiple modes.
• Refer to Page 3-12 for the procedure for resetting AFE
modes.
6.7 Ignition Switch (if equipped) vehicle is being driven, ignition switch remains in the ON
position.
An illuminator ring is
provided on the face of the
ignition switch to help in Do not leave the ignition in ON when the engine is OFF. This
locating the ignition switch could lead to battery drain and ignition switch damage.
at night. The ring will
illuminate the moment the START - This position is to start the engine by cranking the
driver door is opened and starter motor. This is a momentary position. When the key is
will remain glowing till the turned to start position, the starter cranks the engine. Once
driver door is closed. the engine is running, release the key, and the key reverts
back to ON position and the starter motor disengages from
the engine.
The different positions of the ignition switch are:
LOCK - This is the ignition and steering lock position. The
vehicle circuits and engine is completely switched OFF. The Do not continue cranking after the engine has started.
steering wheel is also locked, and the key can be removed
from the ignition only in this position.
ACC - The steering is unlocked and can be rotated. In this If turning the key is difficult, jiggle the steering wheel from
position, all electrical circuits are enabled. Use this mode side to side and try again.
when you want to listen to music, etc., with the engine
temporarily switched OFF. The key can be removed only in the LOCK position. When
the key is removed, the steering column lock is activated,
ON - All electrical circuits are enabled. Some of the warning and the steering wheel cannot be turned.
or information lamps illuminate in this position. While some
of the lamps will go out after a few seconds, some will
continue to remain ON till the engine is started. When the
Never return the key to the LOCK position or try to remove If Horn Switch Input is ON for more than 10 sec, Horn will
the key when the vehicle is in motion. Removing the key get deactivate after 10 sec.
allows the steering wheel to lock. You will lose the control of
the vehicle and may cause serious accident. Remove the key
only when the vehicle is parked. 6.9 Manual Transmission
SET-
RESUME
ENTER
3
2
1
or after 10 sec of
A/C ECON
REAR
A/C
continuously pressing.
NO OFF
USB
The transmission is fully synchronized in all forward gears,
so shifting to either a higher or a lower gear is easily
accomplished. The clutch pedal should be depressed fully
while shifting, and then released slowly.
Gear information shows the actual gear in which user has to This position stops the transmission of power from the
drive the vehicle. engine to drive axle. With the gear lever in neutral and
brakes released, the vehicle can move freely by pushing or
Based on the various parameters, it will suggest to change towing. The engine can be started in this mode. It is always
the gear for better fuel economy with up/down recommended to keep the brake pedal depressed in this
recommendation. position. It is advisable to shift into neutral when the vehicle
is standstill for longer durations with the engine idling.
Display
High
3 4 04:20 AM Low
Drive Info 18 oc 100 120
80 140
2 X 1000 rpm
5
Trip - A
60
Coasting
km/h
160
the vehicle with the gear lever in neutral and
Distance 8888.8km engine ON/OFF is not recommended. In an event of panic
40 180you will not have the power of engine braking to
1 6 Time 88:88hr braking,
Avg. Speed 220km/h 20 slow down
200 the vehicle. This may lead to personal injury or
ENGINE!
7
Hold : Reset accident.
220
999999km
E F 5 C H
Use the gears 1 to 6 as per vehicle load, road/traffic Vehicle Road Speed
conditions or as per requirement. The current gear selection Shift Range Engine RPM Range
(kmph)
is indicated in the cluster.
2–1 14
3–2 25
Always depress the clutch fully before moving the gear lever
4–3 40 1000–1200
from the current position to any desired position. Perform
up-shifts or down-shifts one gear at a time, do not jump 5–4 52
gears. 6–5 61
engine and apply the Parking brake/EPB. When stopping the 6.10 Automatic Transmission (AT)
vehicle on an uphill gradient, do not hold it with the clutch/
accelerator; use the brake to avoid unnecessary clutch 6.10.1 Gear Selector Lever
wear/heat build up.
Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle or with with 6 Speed automatic
access to an unlocked vehicle. Children could move the gear transmission having Electric
lever, which could result in an accident or serious injury. P
R
controls with an Adaptive
+ N
M
- D Transmission Control
On slippery/wet road surfaces, never downshift to obtain Strategy.
braking action. This could result in a wheel slip and reduced
vehicle control.
This adaptive Transmission strategy offers optimal
6.9.7 Uphill and Downhill Driving transmission operation and shift quality in different driving
conditions.
To prevent the engine from high stress at a low RPM when
driving uphill gradients or with your vehicle heavily loaded, The transmission electric are self-calibrating. Therefore, the
downshift when necessary to maintain engine RPM within first few shifts on a new vehicle may be somewhat rough.
the best torque range. Similarly, while driving downhill, This is a normal phenomenon, and precision shifts will
downshift to utilize the engine braking in an optimum develop within the initial few hundred kms of running.
manner. While driving in a continuous down gradient at
high speeds, always engage the appropriate gear to reduce P : Park position M : Manual Shift
aggressive and sustained brake usage. Aggressive and
sustained brake usage can cause higher brake pad R : Reverse position M+ : Manual up-shift
temperatures and fading.
N : Neutral position M- : Manual down shift
D : Drive position
Movement Possibility
DRIVE
NO OFF OFF MODE
time.
D-M No
M-D No
D-N No To shift in to any other position, first depress the brake
pedal, then press knob button and move the TGS to R or N
N-R Yes-Only knob button
or D as desired.
R-P Yes-Only knob button
The current gear lever position is indicated in the centre of • Stop the vehicle completely before shifting into “P”
the cluster display.
• Never shift to “P” when the vehicle is moving, To avoid
damage to transmission
• If the lever is shifted to P when the vehicle has not come
to stop and in forward motion, then a ratchet noise will
be heard. This is not abnormal. However we do not
recommend moving to P till the vehicle has come to
standstill . As repeated such instances can damage the
internal parts
• To shift from the “P” position to another position, the 6.10.4 N : Neutral position
ignition switch must be turned to “ON” and the brake
pedal should be depressed. Any forcible attempts to
move the selector lever from “P” without the two
At this position, the engine
procedures may damage the selector lever
DRIVE
NO OFF OFF MODE
DRIVE
In manual mode, downshifts are made automatically when • To maintain the required levels of vehicle performance
the vehicle slows down. Similarly, upshifts are automatically and safety, the system may not execute certain gearshifts
made when the engine rpm exceeds the threshold. when the shift lever/ tip switch is operated
When starting to drive on a snow or icy road, upshift of the Use of Engine Brake: To use the engine as a brake, change
gear to 2nd or 3rd is possible to avoid loss of traction. into the manual gear shift mode first, then operate the shift
lever to switch to next lower gear.
For safety reason maximum three shifts “+” / ”-” can be
allowed at given point of time.
to release the key. Contact Authorized Mahindra Service available in toolkit, Press the butoon and move the shift lever out
Center at the earliest. of P mode.
ON
SHIFT LOCK
wait for a while until the “D” shift indicator comes on
OF
OF
F
F
with the brake pedal depressed
• When driving on a down hill, never shift the selector lever
SHIFT LOCK
SHIFT LOCK
+N
MD
MD
_
_
P
P
R
W62G116 W62G117
sudden gear engagement can damage the drive train
• HDC (Hill Descent Control) is designed for driving down a
In case of malfunction of the shift lock system or vehicle battery
got drained, Open up the shift lock cap which is present in front of
steep hill. When HDC is applied, do not shift to “N”.
the shift lever on the shift bezel. Then with the help of Screw driver Otherwise, HDC will be deactivated
6.10.12 Engine Braking 6.11 All Wheel Drive (AWD) Operation (if equipped)
When the accelerator pedal is released while the vehicle is in
motion, the engine speed decreases. On a down hill, engaging a In an AWD vehicle, power is
lower gear can generate a higher engine braking and eventually transmitted to all the
slow down the vehicle speed. By using engine behavior as a brake, wheels. This is managed by
you can decrease your vehicle speed without excessively using the the AWD System which
brake system. The lower gear, the higher braking force.
intelligently transfers
torque to all four wheels.
Do not excessively apply the brake pedal while going down a long slope.
The brake system will overheat, experience vapor lock or the fade AWD system includes electromagnetically operated clutch
phenomenon, and lose the braking force which is controlled by an ECU. According to the driving
Be aware that the engine brake does not work when the gear selector lever conditions, this system automatically delivers torque to the
is in the “N” position rear wheels.
Avoid any abrupt engine braking on slippery roads, or the tyres may slip
The transmission is held either in 3rd/ 5th gear when LHM is activated.
6.11.2 AWD Lock Mode When driving on normal roads, deactivate the AWD LOCK
mode by pushing the AWD LOCK button (AWD LOCK
The AWD LOCK mode is to transfer a portion of the drive indicator light goes off). Driving on normal roads with the
torque to the rear wheels for increased traction on wet AWD LOCK mode, especially, when cornering may cause
pavement, snow covered roads or when driving off road. mechanical noise or vibration. The noise and vibration will
disappear when the AWD LOCK mode is deactivated.
Occasional off-road use such as established unpaved roads Prolong driving with the noise and vibration may damage
and trails are OK. It is always important that the driver some parts of the power train.
carefully reduces the speed to a level that does not exceed
the safe operating speed for those conditions.
Use lock mode when driving up or down steep inclines, AWD vehicles have to be towed only with loaded on the back
driving off-road, driving on sandy and muddy roads, etc. to of a truck. This is the safest and best way of towing. If
maximize traction. vehicle needs to be towed by lifting the front wheels, then
the propeller shaft needs to be disconnected in order to
AWD LOCK button is located on the driver control switch protect the coupling.
bank. The LED on the switch turns ON when the AWD Lock is
activated. In this mode, fixed amount of torque is Do not use the AWD lock mode on dry paved roads. Doing
transferred to the rear wheels irrespective of the driving so can cause abnormal noise or vibration, and may
condition. damage the AWD system.
When the vehicle is stuck in the snow , sand or mud, place a
The AWD warning lamp in the cluster non-slip material under the drive wheels to provide traction
illuminates when there is a malfunction in the OR Slowly spin the wheels in forward and reverse directions
AWD system. which causes a rocking motion that may free the vehicle.
However, avoid running the engine continuously at high
rpm, doing so may damage the AWD system.
In AWD Lock mode, when vehicle speed > 80 km/h, then
system changes to AUTO mode automatically .
6.12 Drive Modes (Only for Diesel Variant) Infotainment Home Screen
Use any of the following methods to activate Drive mode Select Drive mode icon from Infotainment Home screen and
select required drive mode as shown in the image below.
Center Fascia Switch Bank
Press Drive mode hard switch on center fascia switch bank
and select required drive mode from Infotainment Screen
DRIVE
OFF OFF MODE
Driving modes alters Once any of the modes is selected, we would have an ALERT
message in cluster. Based on the mode selected the Alert
1. Sensitivity of Accelerator pedal along with engine message would vary. for
power delivery
ZAP: ZAP MODE ACTIVATED
2. Gear shift patterns
ZIP: ZIP MODE ACTIVATED
3. Steering effort
4. TCS Control ZOOM: ZOOM MODE ACTIVATED
Based on the mode selected driving Once selected we would have a permanent indication in the
CLUSTER. Also, the skin of the cluster also changes as per
ZAP Mode: ZAP Mode offers regular everyday performance. the mode.
The car runs like a true Mahindra should. It offers a good
balance between ZIP and ZOOM settings and is ideal for Allows the driver to alter settings to their specific
day-to-day use. The vehicle will be default in ZAP mode preferences. This option offers further flexibility over
every time the vehicle Ignition is turned ON. This is the choices of Drive Modes.
default mode.
This is done by means of CUSTOM MODES available in
ZIP Mode: ZIP mode is the accelerator pedal response and Infotainment screens.
shift points (in AT) have been modified so as to have
Here, the Customer is provided with Selection option from
comfortable and easy control for traffic condition.
choices as seen below
ZOOM Mode: This mode is for a more spirited driving. ZOOM
mode is offered to make the car more fun, as it produces more
Power train : ZIP , ZAP or ZOOM
engaging and potent ride-quality. In this mode, accelerator will Braking : ZAP or ZOOM
become more responsive, i.e. the car accelerates more readily.
The steering gets heavier, Gear shift and is delayed. Steering: ZIP or ZAP or ZOOM
HVAC : Normal or Economy
Once the customer selects his/her choice from drop down 6.13 Micro Hybrid Technology (Engine Stop/Start
on confirming his/her choice. Each of the individual System) – MT/AT (If equipped)
controllers will switch to this selection.
Engine Stop/Start system automatically “stops” and “starts”
Few things to note the engine when idle at signals or long traffic jams. This in
1. When in Cruise control or Adaptive cruise control turn gives a better fuel efficiency.
Vehicle will always be defaulted to ZAP MODE
2. ON every IGNITION Cycle, vehicle will always start in 6.13.1 Overview of the Engine Stop/Start System –
ZAP MODE MT
3. IN case of any faults at vehicle level , that doesn't
allow the vehicle to be in the mode of choice
Customer is alerted by an alert message – “DRIVE
MODE INHIBITED” in Infotainment screen and the
Mode choice in the Cluster would be Blank.
How does the Engine Stop/Start System Work? • Bonnet is fully closed
• In the current ignition cycle, the vehicle has crossed 7
Let’s take a simple example of driving in traffic conditions
kmph at least once
within your city. Assume that your vehicle has stopped at a
traffic junction due to a red signal. The following steps • Current status of the engine is idling
illustrate how the system functions:
• Vehicle speed is zero
• The vehicle has come to a halt at a traffic signal, is in the
neutral gear and the clutch pedal is released • Accelerator pedal and clutch pedal are fully released
• The Engine Stop/Start lamp in the cluster will blink • Vehicle battery should be in healthy condition
indicating that the engine is going to stop shortly. The • Engine is warm (Engine coolant temperature is between
engine will shut down automatically after a specific time 25 degree C and 100 degree C). This is an extra
period precaution to ensure safe working of the engine
• The Engine Stop/Start lamp will illuminate in the • Fuel temperature is less than 60 degree C
instrument cluster indicating the engine was stopped by
the “Engine Stop/Start” System • Gear in neutral
• Once the signal turns green, press the clutch pedal and • DPF REGEN should not be in active state
the engine starts immediately
• Vehicle should not have DEF error codes E14, E24 & E34l
• OBD and CHECK ENGINE telltale in OFF condition 6.13.2 Overview of the Engine Stop/Start System –
For auto start to happen, the following conditions are to AT
be met:
• Vehicle should have been stopped by the Engine Stop/
Start System
SHIFT LOCK
de-pressed
-
+N
MD
-
How does the Engine Stop/Start System Work? • In the current ignition cycle, the vehicle has crossed 10
kmph at least once
Let’s take a simple example of driving in traffic conditions
within your city. Assume that your vehicle has stopped at a • Current status of the engine is idling
traffic junction due to a red signal. The following steps
illustrate how the system functions: • Vehicle speed is zero
• The vehicle has come to a halt at a traffic signal, is in the • Brake pedal is fully pressed
“D” Mode and the brake pedal is pressed • Vehicle battery should be in healthy condition
• The Engine Stop/Start lamp in the cluster will blink • Engine is warm (Engine coolant temperature is between
indicating that the engine is going to stop shortly. The 25 degree C and 100 degree C). This is an extra
engine will shut down automatically after a specific time precaution to ensure safe working of the engine
period
• Fuel temperature is less than 60 degree C
• The Engine Stop/Start lamp will illuminate in the
instrument cluster indicating the engine was stopped by • Gear shift Lever in ‘D’ mode
the “Engine Stop/Start” System
• Vehicle should not be in slope
• Once the signal turns green, release the brake pedal and
the engine starts immediately
• DPF REGEN should not be in active state
• The indicator in the cluster goes OFF indicating that the • Vehicle should not have DEF error codes E14, E24 & E34l
engine has started again and you are ready to drive on • AT Warning telltale in OFF condition
For auto stop to happen, the following conditions are to • OBD and CHECK ENGINE telltale in OFF condition
be met:
For auto start to happen, the following conditions are to
• Engine Stop/Start system is in active condition by default be met:
and should not be turned off using the selection switch
• Vehicle should have been stopped by the Engine Stop/
• Bonnet is fully closed Start System
• Gear lever is in ‘D’ mode and brake pedal is fully released 3. Is it possible to start the engine through the clutch
pedal for the first time?
• Vehicle speed is zero
No, the engine can be cranked only with the ignition
• Engine Stop/Start System is in active state key for the first time. If the engine is stopped
• Bonnet should be closed automatically by the system, only then it is possible to
start the engine through clutch pedal in MT
7. Whether the A/C will function, if the engine is switched 12. Whether the system will stop my engine in moving
off? traffic?
No, the A/C will not work. However, the blower will be No, the engine will be stopped only when the vehicle
in operation when the ignition is ON. speed is zero.
8. What will happen if I keep the clutch continuously 13. Whether the audio system will be switched OFF, when
pressed at traffic signals/jams? the engine shuts down?
The system will not stop the engine if the clutch is No, the audio system will not be switched OFF and you
continuously pressed since it indicates the driver’s can continue to enjoy the music.
intention of moving the vehicle immediately.
14. Whether the engine will re-crank whenever the clutch
9. When the battery charge is low, whether the engine pedal is pressed in MT?
will be switched off?
No, when the engine is running, the starter motor will
If the battery charge drops below a certain threshold not attempt to re-crank.
level, the system will not stop the engine so as to
preserve the battery from further draining. 15. If any component involved in the system fails, what
will happen?
10. Whether I will be able to operate the engine with the
normal ignition key? The system has a built-in diagnostic module which
understands the failure and immediately goes to
Yes, normal operation with the ignition key is always bypass mode. In the bypass mode, the engine can be
possible. turned ON and OFF by ignition key as usual.
11. Whether the vehicle will start (or) stop in gear for MT?
The vehicle will not start or stop automatically in gear
to ensure safety. It will do so only in the neutral
position of the gear lever.
6.14 Fuel-BS VI i
CAUTION
For Diesel: Use
commercially available
vehicular Ultra-low Sulfur
Highway Diesel that meets For Petrol (Automatic Transmission) - Use only
the BIS standard (IS 1460; commercially available Petrol fuel conforming to IS 2796:
2017 BS VI specification or 2017 BS-VI specification or equivalent and / or E20 fuel
equivalent). Information on confirming to IS17021;2018 specification. In either case of
diesel quality can normally fuel, minimum Research Octane Number (RON) to be 95.
be found in the fuel pump. Information on Petrol quality can normally be found in the
fuel pump. Please contact filling station personnel in case
labels in the pump cannot be found.
Please contact filling station personnel in case labels in the
pump cannot be found. If the diesel fuel with high sulfur i
content (more than 10 PPM) and unspecified additives are
CAUTION
used, it can cause the DPF system damage and emission E20/E10 FUEL ONLY (Min.RON 95)
warranty issues. DO NOT OVER FILL AFTER AUTO CUT-OFF
Do not fill the fuel tank or mix the fuel with alcohol based Diesel/Petrol is highly flammable and poisonous. It burns
fuels, kerosene, etc. This will damage the engine, fuel and violently and can cause serious injury. Never allow sparks,
exhaust system components. flames or smoking materials near diesel/Petrol. Turn OFF
If you have accidentally filled the fuel tank with incorrect or the engine before refuelling. Whenever you are around
non- approved fuel, do not start the vehicle. Contact an diesel/Petrol, extinguish all smoking materials.
Authorized Mahindra Dealer to have the fuel system
drained completely. 6.14.2 Minimum Fuel Requirement
6.15 Brakes
Your vehicle is equipped with disc brakes in the front and Driving with wet brakes is dangerous. Stopping distance
rear wheels. increases considerably while braking
If you have to park the vehicle with front side facing the While driving in a continuous down gradient at high speeds,
uphill, select first gear for MT vehicle & park position for AT always engage the appropriate gear to reduce aggressive
vehicles and also turn the front wheels away from the kerb. and sustained brake usage. Aggressive and sustained brake
usage can cause higher brake pad temperatures and
If you have to park the vehicle with front side facing fading.
downhill, select reverse gear and turn the front wheels
towards the kerb.
6.15.2 Parking Brake – Manual (if equipped)
Always ensure that the vehicle is in gear and parking brakes
is engaged before leaving the vehicle.
To apply the parking brake,
pull the park brake lever up
Parking on uphill
as firmly as possible. When
the parking brake is applied
When parking on an uphill, turn the front with the ignition ON, the
wheels away from the Kerb/Pavement parking brake warning
lamp in the instrument
cluster illuminates.
Y4D053
Parking on downhill To release the parking brake, pull the parking brake lever up
slightly, press the release button on the lever tip and lower
the parking brake lever completely.
When parking on a downhill, turn the front
wheels towards the Kerb/Pavement.
application. Be sure the parking brake is firmly set when • The parking brake should always be applied when the
parked and the gear shift lever is in gear. When parking on driver is not in the vehicle
a hill; first apply the parking brake; after that shift the TGS
lever to the P position (for AT) and gear for MT. This will
avoid the load on the transmission, locking mechanism may 6.16 Electric Parking Brake-EPB (if equipped)
make it difficult to move the shift lever out of gear.
The EPB (Electronic Parking Brake) is a safety feature with
enhanced comfort, the parking brakes are applied/released
by simple switch operation.
Be sure the parking brake is fully disengaged before driving
off. Failure to do so can lead to brake problems due to The EPB system replaces the conventional manual parking
excessive heating of the rear brakes. It will also result in brake which requires high effort to apply & release.
reduced fuel efficiency lowered brake pad life and rear In addition to the switch based Apply, EPB also provides
brake squeal additional safety/comfort features like EPB auto apply, auto
• Engaging the parking brake while the vehicle is in motion release, Auto vehicle hold, Controlled deceleration for
can cause the rear wheels to lock up. You could lose parking, rear wheel un-locker and roll away re-clamp.
control of the vehicle and cause an accident
• Always apply the parking brake when leaving the vehicle, 6.16.1 Applying EPB
and be certain to leave the transmission in gear. Failure
to do so may allow the vehicle to roll and cause damage,
hit a bystander resulting in personal injury
• Leaving unattended children in a vehicle is dangerous for Park the vehicle in a safe
a number of reasons. Children should be warned not to place and pull up the EPB
touch the parking brake or the gear shift lever. Do not switch.
leave the key in the ignition. A child could move the AUTO
HOLD
The parking brake warning lamp on the 6.16.3 AUTO Apply EPB
instrument cluster and the red Illumination on
the EPB switch is turned on, indicating that the For added comfort and for safety reasons the EPB will
parking brake is applied. get automatically applied in the following conditions.
1. Ignition is turned Off.
6.16.2 Releasing EPB
2. AT vehicle –gear shifted to Park
3. Auto Vehicle Hold (AVH) in Active state and Driver
door open.
Press down the EPB switch 4. Auto Vehicle Hold (AVH) in Active state and Driver seat
with the brake pedal belt unbuckled.
depressed.
AUTO
HOLD
5. Auto Vehicle Hold (AVH) in Active state and AVH switch
pressed to release AVH Active state.
6. Auto Vehicle Hold (AVH) in active state continuously
for more than 5 minutes
The parking brake warning lamp on the
instrument cluster and the red Illumination on 7. Auto vehicle hold (AVH) active and engine turned OFF
the EPB switch is turned off, indicating that the by engine start stop feature
parking brake is released.
How to override EPB Auto Apply – MT • Push and hold the EPB switch, simultaneously press and
hold the start stop button (SSB) till ignition is turned OFF.
If in any case, EPB auto apply feature needs to be
overridden, it can be achieved by a simple switch-based • This operation prevents EPB auto apply and EPB will be in
operation, which is mentioned below: disengaged state.
1. Stop the vehicle
2. Push and hold EPB switch in release position In this case, vehicle remains in accessory state (SSB LED in
amber color) before completely getting turned OFF, for 30
3. Holding the EPB switch in released position, turn the seconds or till driver door is opened.
ignition OFF
4. This prevents EPB from automatically getting applied 6.16.4 AUTO Releasing EPB/Drive Away
For Automatic Transmission Vehicles (AT)
In any case, where the vehicle needs to be moved in ignition
OFF condition, EPB auto apply override feature to be 1. Close the driver door and fasten the driver seat belt.
utlilized. 2. Shift the gear selector lever to the D / M or R position
In case of any Switch related failure when vehicle in
3. Release the brake pedal and then depress the
standstill, the EPB Auto release feature must be used to
accelerator pedal slowly.
release EPB, if EPB Auto release feature doesn’t work,
contact Service center in such cases to release the EPB 4. The EPB is released automatically, thus enabling
forward or backward movement of the vehicle.
How to override EPB Auto Apply – AT
5. The red Illumination on the EPB switch and the brake
EPB manual override feature can be used to push the tell-tale on cluster is turned off, indicating that the
vehicle after turning the ignition OFF or in any breakdown parking brake is released.
condition.
• Position TGS lever in neutral (N).
For Manual Transmission Vehicles (MT) 6.16.5 EPB Warning Lamp / Parking Brake Warning
Lamp
1. Close the driver door and fasten the driver seat belt.
2. Shift the gear to forward or reverse gear. This tell-tale is turned ON in the cluster when EPB
3. Then slowly release the clutch pedal and depress the is applied properly.
Accelerator pedal to drive away.
This tell-tale is turned ON in the cluster when there
4. The EPB is released automatically, thus enabling is a malfunction in the EPB system.
forward or backward movement of the vehicle.
5. The red Illumination on the EPB switch and the brake If the warning lamp is turned on, have the vehicle checked
tell-tale on cluster is turned off, indicating that the and serviced at a Mahindra Dealer or Mahindra Authorized
parking brake is released. Service Centre
Do’s
The EPB AUTO release function will not be activated if driver Driving Conditions
door is not closed or if the driver seat belt is not fastened. • For EPB Auto release and Drive Away always wear driver
The driver will get message on cluster to ensure the same. seat belt and ensure that the driver door is closed
If the EPB is being released using the accelerator pedal , be
cautious if the vehicle is parked uphill. In this scenario if an • In MT vehicles, drive away with clutch alone modulation
aggressive accelerator pedal input is given, it can also result not possible, thus always modulate the clutch pedal and
in wheel spin. The wheel spin will cause ESP to intervene. accelerator pedal for effective drive away.
Don’ts • If the EPB warning lamp stays on, have the vehicle
serviced at a Mahindra Dealer or Mahindra Authorised
Driving Conditions Service Centre.
• If the EPB Malfunction lamp is ON and the brake is • Do not let children or other people who are not familiar
engaged. Do not drive. with the EPB system operate the EPB switch. There is a
• Avoid using EPB after doing water wading. Please get the danger of accidents depending on the parking/stationary
vehicle checked in workshop. state of the vehicle.
Servicing: Do not get your vehicle serviced at an • If you hear noises or smell a burnt odor from the related
unauthorized service center. components after using the EPB emergency mode, have
the vehicle checked and serviced
• The EPB can also be used in cases of emergency braking. 6.17 Auto Vehicle Hold/Auto Hold (AVH) (if
Release the accelerator and Pull and hold the EPB button equipped)
until your vehicle comes to standstill and EPB gets
applied. This should be done only in emergency The AVH is a comfort feature offered with Electric parking
condition and not as a regular action. brake.
• The braking process is interrupted when the EPB button The function of AVH is to hold the vehicle in standstill with
is released or the accelerator pedal is actuated in the applied driver brake pressure
dynamic condition
Once AVH switch is pressed, it remains in memory and thus
driver doesn’t have to press AVH switch every time
The AVH feature can exist in 4 states in the vehicle, which 6.17.1 Activation of AVH
are as follows.
AVH Off – AVH switch is not pressed, thus AVH is 1. Ensure driver door
not available. closed and Driver
seat belt buckled
AUTO AVH Standby – AVH is available but is in standby 2. Press the AUTO HOLD
HOLD mode. switch button. Auto
AUTO
HOLD
Hold tell-tale in
AUTO AVH Active – AVH is available and is controlling/ cluster goes to
HOLD holding the vehicle in standstill. standby.
Operating Auto hold • Do not depress the accelerator pedal abruptly with the
AUTO HOLD function is activated. Otherwise, the parking
1. Pressing the AUTO HOLD switch turns on the AUTO brake is released, and the vehicle can accelerate
HOLD indicator on cluster (white). suddenly
2. Depress the brake pedal while driving to stop the • If the EPB warning lamp is turned on or there is a fault in
vehicle. the EPB system, have the vehicle checked and serviced at
3. The color of AUTO HOLD indicator on the instrument a Mahindra Dealer or Mahindra Authorised Service
cluster is changed from white to green and the brake Centre. If parking the vehicle is required in an
is applied. emergency, pull over the vehicle on a flat surface and
chock the wheels after shifting the gear selector lever to
4. Slowly depress the accelerator pedal when driving off. the P position
5. The color of AUTO HOLD indicator on the instrument Controlled Deceleration for Parking (CDP)
cluster is changed from green to white and the brake
is released. • The Controlled Deceleration for parking is a safety
feature.
• The CDP functions can be made used in any case such as
If the AUTO HOLD function remains active for more than 5 Brake pedal/Brake Booster/Master Cylinder failure
minutes or if the driver door is opened/seat belt is because of which sufficient brake force can’t be achieved
unbuckled the EPB applies automatically and AVH is through the brake pedal.
disabled.
• In such conditions, pulling the EPB Switch triggers the ESP
Control unit to generate a pressure build up in the brake
system which produces the braking force at individual
• When driving off on a downhill by depressing the wheels to bring the vehicle to an emergency stop.
accelerator pedal, be careful as the vehicle can
accelerate suddenly and on uphill sufficient accelerator
pedal input to be provided for overcoming the gradient.
• For unintentional application, if the codriver or any other The EPB is a complex system involving electrical and
person pulls the EPB switch without driver’s notice in hydraulics, it is strictly advised to get it repaired or serviced
dynamic condition, The CDP function can be overridden in a Mahindra Authorized service Centre .
by the driver by pressing Accelerator pedal.
6.17.3 Electric Parking Brake (EPB) Alert
• The CDP functionality having a high rate of deceleration, Display Operating Conditions
anyone other than the driver must be advised not to pull
the EPB switch in any case while driving. This message is displayed on the
Cluster when the EPB switch is
• The CDP function is a safety feature and must be used in released without depressing the
the cases of emergency only.
brake pedal to deactivate EPB.
EPB Roll Away Re-clamp
• If the EPB system detects any rolling after EPB is applied, This message is displayed on the
the motor on caliper re-clamps the disc to avoid any Cluster in the following conditions:
rolling. 1. When the accelerator pedal is
depressed to auto release EPB, with
• As an added feature, to avoid roll away due the reduction EPB Applied and driver door open/
in clamp force due to decrease in temperature, the EPB driver seat belt unbuckled.
motor on caliper re-clamps the disc multiple times based
on the temperature. 2. When the AVH switch is depressed
to activate AVH, with driver door
open/driver seat belt unbuckled.
6.18 Hazard on Panic Braking recommended to hold the brake pedal firmly while the ABS
is active rather than pumping the brake pedal.
Hazard lamps are turned ON during panic braking for 5
seconds when the following conditions are met: Depressing the brake pedal on slippery road surfaces as on
a manhole cover, a steel plate at a construction site, a joint
• Ignition is ON in a bridge, etc. on a rainy day, tends to activate the anti-lock
brake system.
• Vehicle speed is greater than 60 kmph
The ABS warning lamp lights up when you
• Panic/sudden brake is applied and high deceleration rate
switch ON the ignition and should go out after
is sensed
a few seconds. If the ABS warning lamp does
not go out or if it comes ON while driving, it means there is a
6.19 Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) fault in the ABS system. In both cases, the normal braking
system remains efficient, exactly as on a vehicle without
The Anti-lock Brake System (also called as ABS) is designed ABS. The vehicle should be examined as soon as possible by
to help prevent lock-up of the wheels and stable stopping of an Mahindra Authorised Dealer.
vehicle during a sudden, panic emergency braking or
braking on slippery road surfaces. The ABS system takes The ABS is not designed to shorten the stopping distance:
input from wheel speed sensors and brake pedal switch to Always drive at a moderate speed and maintain a safe
control the brake fluid pressures at the wheels to avoid distance from the vehicle in front of you. The stopping
wheel lock-up. It allows vehicle to be steered during braking. distance may be longer in the following cases:
The minimum speed for ABS to function is 12 kmph. ABS is • Driving on rough, gravel or snow-covered roads
activated only during wheel lock conditions where ABS takes • Driving with tyre chains installed
over and prevents wheel lock.
• Driving over the steps such as the joints on the road
During the ABS operation, a slight pulsation may be felt in
the brake pedal to indicate ABS is active. You may also hear • Driving on roads where the road surface is potholes or
motor noise from the engine compartment. It is large differences in surface height
the prevailing road conditions. The ESP cannot prevent 6.21.2 ESP OFF
accidents, including those resulting from excessive speed in
turns, driving on very slippery surfaces, or hydroplaning.
Only a safe, attentive, and skilful driver can prevent
accidents. The capabilities of an ESP-equipped vehicle can In some driving conditions,
not compensate for reckless or dangerous driving that to maximize traction, it may
could endanger the user’s safety or the safety of others on be beneficial to de-activate
road or passerby. ESP.
6.21.1 ESP ON
Such conditions are:
Whenever the vehicle is started, the ESP • To start in deep snow or on a loose surface
system will be in active mode. This mode
should be used for most driving conditions. • Driving in deep sand
• Driving through deep mud etc.
To de-activate ESP, press ESP OFF button on
When the ESP is in operation, ESP indicator lamp will blink the driver control switch bank. Once ESP OFF
in the instrument cluster. mode is selected, a warning indicator
When the ESP is operating, you can feel a slight pulsation in illuminates in the instrument cluster.
the brake pedal. This is normal and indicates that braking
had gone to ABS zone. Suggest that the driver should slow Press ESP OFF button again to activate ESP function.
down the speed are not matching the road surface.
When moving out of the mud or slippery road, accelerator
response may be different because ESP system controls the For safety reasons, ESP will be automatically re-activated
engine RPM to come out of this slippery road condition. This once the vehicle speed crosses 64 kmph
is normal. Mahindra recommends that ESP be operational in all
normal driving conditions.
6.23 Hill Descent Control (HDC) (if equipped) While HDC is controlling the vehicle speed, descent speeds
can be varied by cruise buttons, accelerator pedal & brake
This System assists the pedal.
driver to descend a steep To Set the desired descending speed, follow the steps listed
slope by means of brake below:
intervention limiting the
vehicle speed without • SET Speed — This is the driver desired speed at which
driver's input on brakes. vehicle should descent. This can be set using HDC switch
This does not replace cruise or brake/accelerator pedals. (example: when the driver
control activates HDC at a speed of 30 kmph, then set speed will
be 30 kmph). HDC will limit vehicle descent speed to set
During HDC, if the wheel slip becomes excessive, ABS will be value).
activated automatically.
• If driver presses the accelerator pedal and increases the
HDC is a user-intended function. To activate, press HDC speed from 30 kmph to 34 kmph and then releases the
button on the driver control switch bank. The LED on the accelerator pedal. Now the new SET speed will be 34
button illuminates indicating the status. Press the button kmph
again to deactivate HDC.
• Similarly, if the driver applies brake and reduces the
The HDC feature can control the vehicle speed from 8 kmph speed from 30 kmph to 10 kmph and then releases the
to 35 kmph, Above 35 kmph the HDC feature will go to ready brake pedal, now the new SET speed will be 10 kmph
mode. The HDC feature will be deactivated automatically if
vehicle speed is more than 60 kmph. (For Activating the HDC • If the vehicle cruise speed is with in the HDC active
feature again, the driver needs to press the HDC button region, similarly the set speed can be modified using
once again within the specified speed limits) cruise +/- buttons (by tapping the “SET —” or “SET +”
buttons. Each press of the button will adjust the speed by
The HDC should be enabled only on steep gradient. It is not approximately 0.5 kmph)
recommended to be ON in plain road- to avoid accidental
intervention The descent speed increases only if the gradient is
sufficiently steep to cause the vehicle to accelerate as the
Imagine a situation where your vehicle is stopped on an • Vehicle Facing Uphill – Gear should be in Forward
uphill incline. If you release the brake while moving off, • Vehicle Facing Downhill – Gear should be in Reverse
there are chances that your vehicle may roll back. HHC
helps in such situations by holding the vehicle from rolling
back.
• In some situations, when the conditions are not met, the
Hill Hold Control function uses the inbuilt acceleration HHC may not get activated. In such cases slight rolling
sensor to identify the gradient and holds the vehicle for 2 may occur.
seconds in MT and 1 seconds in AT vehicles after the brake
pedals are released. If the driver does not apply the throttle • The Safety of the vehicles always lies in the hands of the
before this time expires, the system will release brake driver, never rely on the HHC system to prevent rolling.
pressure and the vehicle will roll down the hill as normal
The Following conditions must be met in order for the HHC 6.25 Hydraulic Fade Compensation (HFC)
to activate:
Due to continuous brake operations, the temperature of the
1. The Vehicle must be equipped with HHC brake disc may get raised, due to which the friction between
2. The vehicle must be on sufficient gradient the brake pads and the brake disc may get reduced
alarmingly, this is known as Brake Fading.
3. The Parking brake must not be applied
HFC provides an additional braking-force boost to the
driver, based on the pad temperature model, brake
pressure and deceleration rate, to reduce the braking
distances in such cases.
The HFC will activate only during high brake pedal force Maximum Vehicle speed for ROM = 120 kmph
application.
3. The Wipers must be in ON condition (Low/High Speed) 6.29 Second Collision Mitigation System (SCM)
The Pressure generated in the BDW function is very small
The SCM feature in the ESP system is an autonomous
and this is not felt by the driver during normal driving
braking system which decreases the speed of the vehicle
conditions. after the first collision by means of autonomous braking
interventions. This reduces the risk of a subsequent crash
due to uncontrolled vehicle movement.
• The system will not be able to sense water splashed on disc For the Second Collision Mitigation feature to get activated,
from situations such as water wash or water puddles.
the following conditions must be met.
• It is suggested that the driver dry the brakes in the above said
conditions by driving at very slow speed and applying the 1. There must be a front collision detected with a certain
brakes lightly until the brake performance becomes normal. severity, where airbags gets deployed
2. The impact speed must be greater than approx. 10
6.28 Electric Brake Prefill - EBP km/h.
Quite Sleepy
Very Sleepy
Your vehicle is originally equipped with tyres supplied by a Callout (A) : 235 (Three-digit number) : This number gives
reputable manufacturer. If you ever have any questions the width in millimetres of the tyre from sidewall edge to
regarding your tyres, please refer to literature supplied by sidewall edge. This is called as “Section Width”.
the tyre manufacturer, or to the separate tyre warranty
provided by the tyre manufacturer. You may also contact Callout (B) : 65 (Two-digit number) : This number, known
Mahindra Authorised Dealer directly, or the tyre as the aspect ratio, gives the tyres ratio of height to section
manufacturer. width.
The tyre rating of your vehicle is: Callout (C) : R : This is the Tyre Construction Code. The “R”
stands for Radial.
• 235/65 R17 103/104 V/H
Callout (D) :17 (Two-digit number) : This number is the MAX. SPEED CAPABILITY
wheel or rim diameter in inches. SPEED SYMBOL
KM/HR
Callout (E) :104 (Two or three-digit number) : This number T 190
is the tyres load index. It is a measurement of how much
weight each tyre can support. U 200
H 210
Callout (F) : H : Tyre speed rating or speed symbol. Never
drive the vehicle faster than the tyre speed rating. The V 240
speed rating denotes the speed at which a tyre is designed
to be driven for extended periods of time under a standard W 270
condition of load and inflation pressure. Y 300
Z 240+
6.31.3 Speed Rating
Dynamic Rolling
radius (mm) 358 +/- 5 358 +/- 5
The proper cold Tyre inflation pressure is listed in the Tyre
Label (Vehicle Placard), located on the front passenger side
inner B-pillar.
The Tyre pressure should be checked and adjusted, as well Safe operation of your vehicle requires that your Tyres are
as inspected for signs of Tyre wear or visible damage, at properly inflated. Remember that a Tyre can lose up to half
least once a month. Use a good quality pressure gauge to of its air pressure without appearing flat.
check Tyre pressure. Do not make a visual judgement when
determining proper inflation. Radial Tyres may look properly At least once a month or before long trips, inspect each Tyre
inflated even when they are underinflated. At the same and check the Tyre pressure with a Tyre gauge (including
time, each Tyre should be inspected for signs of Tyre wear spare Tyre). Inflate all Tyres to the recommended inflation
or visible damage. pressure.
When it was new, the spare Tyre in your vehicle was fully • Over or under inflation may reduce the tyre life
inflated. However, a spare Tyre can lose pressure over time. • Do not correct the tyre pressure immediately after the
In order to avoid being stranded, check the spare Tyre air vehicle is stopped after operation, server handling or
pressure frequently. long distance drive. Check the inflation pressure when
the vehicle is idle for 3 hours or 10 minutes of driving
after 3 hours in idle condition
• Do not drive the vehicle with lower pressure than 6.31.8 Radial Ply Tyres
recommended, which may lead to over heating of
sidewall resulting in tyre damage
• Check the tyre pressures once in a month or before long Combining radial ply Tyres with other types of Tyres on your
distance travels vehicle will cause your vehicle to handle poorly, resulting in
• Check your tyres regularly for any damages or cut on the an accident and/or personal injury. Always use radial Tyres
sidewall. Please replace the tyres immediately. in sets of four. Never combine them with other types of
Tyres.
Always inflate your Tyres to the recommended pressure Cuts and punctures in radial Tyres are repairable only in the
even if it is less than the maximum inflation pressure tread area because of sidewall flexing. Consult your
information found on the Tyre. The recommended Tyre Mahindra Authorised Dealer for radial Tyre repairs.
inflation pressure is found on the Tyre Label which is
located on the front passenger side inner B-pillar. Failure to
follow the Tyre pressure recommendations can cause 6.31.9 Tread Wear Indicators (TWI)
uneven tread wear patterns and adversely affect the way
your vehicle handles. Tread wear indicators are moulded into the bottom of the
tread grooves. They will appear as bands when the tread
depth becomes 1/16 inch (2 mm). When the indicators
appear in two or more adjacent grooves, the Tyre should be
If you overfill the Tyre, release air by pushing the metal stem replaced.
in the centre of the valve. Then recheck the pressure.
6.31.10 Life of Tyre and suspension components. You could lose control of the
vehicle or the Tyre can unexpectedly fail, resulting in an
The service life of a Tyre is dependent upon various factors accident and/or personal injury.
including but not limited to:
• Driving style
Replacing original Tyres with Tyres of a different size may
• Tyre pressure result in false speedometer and odometer readings.
• Distance driven
6.31.11 Snow Chains
Tyres and the spare Tyre should be replaced after six years, Snow chains cannot be used on these Tyres.
regardless of the remaining tread. Failure to follow this
warning can result in sudden and unexpected Tyre failure,
leading to an accident and/or personal injury.
In case of harsh winter driving conditions, it is
recommended using winter Tyres with the same
specifications for better stability, safety and performance.
Keep dismounted Tyres in a cool, dry place with as little
exposure to light as possible. Protect Tyres from contact
with oil, grease and fuels.
Do not use a Tyre, wheel size or speed rating other than that
specified for your vehicle on the Tyre placard. Combinations
of unapproved Tyres and wheels may change suspension
geometric and performance characteristics, resulting in
changes to steering, handling and braking of your vehicle.
This can cause unpredictable handling, stress to steering
6.31.12 Tyre Rotation Recommendations Type 2 – Applicable for All wheel Drive Vehicles
Type 1 - Applicable for Front wheel Drive Vehicles It is recommended rotating the tyres as per the
“Maintenance Schedule”.
The suggested rotation method is the “forward-cross”
Tyres on the front and rear
VVehicle shown in the diagram. The benefits of rotation are
Front
axles of vehicles operate at
especially worthwhile with aggressive tread designs such as
different loads and perform
those on On/Off-road type tyres.
different steering, handling,
and braking functions. For
these reasons, they wear at Rotation will increase tread
Vehicle
unequal rates and develop V
6.31.13 Temporary Spare Wheel • While using Temporary spare wheel reduce speed, Avoid
sharp cornering, Avoid sudden acceleration, abrupt
steering, sudden braking and shifting operations that
Regular Tyre Temporary Tyre cause sudden engine braking.
When Temporary Spare Wheel is attached
V V
pressure limits and warning messages have been 6.32.2 Tiretronics Warning Lamp
established and calibrated for the tyre size equipped on
your vehicle. Replacement of manufacturer’s parts with a The Tiretronics warning lamp in the instrument
different size, type or style of components may damage the cluster illuminates for any alert condition and
sensor and lead to incorrect readings. also for low/high tyre pressure/High
temperature alerts and malfunction.
Do not use aftermarket tyre sealants or balance beads if
your vehicle is equipped with Tiretronics. Failure to comply
may lead to sensor damage. 6.32.3 Tiretronics Sensor Installation
The Tiretronics is not intended to replace normal tyre care
and maintenance or to warn of any tyre failure condition. First apply lubricant (paste)
The system should not be used as a replacement for a or soapy water to rim hole
pressure measuring gauge to adjust the vehicle tyre or valve nozzle bar, as
pressure. shown in the following
figure (the diagram is for
Driving with under-inflated tyres cause the tyres to overheat reference only, and it is
and may lead to tyre failure. Under-inflated tyres reduce operated according to the
fuel efficiency, tyre tread life and may affect the vehicle's degree of automation of
maneuverability and braking ability. the customer's production
line)
It is the driver's responsibility to maintain correct tyre
pressure using an accurate pressure gauge, even if under-
inflation has not reached the level to trigger illumination of
the Tiretronics warning indicator.
1. Line the sensor up with the rim hole and attach the 6.32.4 Tiretronics Sensor Removal
TTV insertion tool to the end of the valve ready for pull
in
2. Ensure the TTV insertion tool is positioned to the • Remove the tyre from
correct notch and that the sensor is pulled through in
the rim
a direction parallel to the valve whole axis and NOT at
an angle to it • Remove the valve core to
deflate the tyre.
3. The picture below shows a correctly fitted sensor.
Note the rubber bulb of the valve resting against the
rim and the front face of the enclosure is NOT
touching the rim. Apply tyre soap solution to the
rubber portion of the valve stem and the top of the • Remove the tread and ensure that the extractor forceps
enclosure is inserted into the tyre at the yellow position shown
below and turn the rim clockwise.
4. Place the inner tyre bead over the rim
5. Place the outer tyre bead over the rim
W12L51
• To remove the sensor, firstly remove the screw using a T6 • Cut the rubber bulb and attach the TTV tool to the valve.
TORX screwdriver. Remove the valve from the rim by pulling through the
rim, or simply pull through without cutting the bulb
• Lift the outer tyre bead over the rim using a tyre tool
Pressure leakage
High pressure monitoring is
monitoring is to indicate
to indicate high pressure
pressure leakage in any of
alert. Please note the
the vehicle tyres. Please
following points.
note the following points.
• High pressure alert will be set only when the tyre • Pressure Leakage alert will be set only when the tyre
pressure value goes above threshold pressure is leaking at a rate greater than defined
threshold
• High pressure alert in the main alert screen will pop up
once for driver notification when the alert is set and the • In the pressure leakage condition if the tyre pressure
vehicle is in running condition. Otherwise the alert will goes too below threshold then the low pressure alert will
remain in the tiretronics screen also be set
• If high pressure value is observed, air has to be released • The pressure leakage alert in the main alert screen will
from the respective tyre until the pressure reduces to the pop up once when the alert is set for driver notification
placard value and will be shown in tiretronics screen when the vehicle
is in running /ignition ON condition
• The vehicle should be driven above 40 kmph for the new
pressure value to be updated and the alert to be cleared • Once pressure leakage is observed the respective tyre
should be observed for air leakages and the puncture
• Once the high pressure alert is triggered the alert shall condition has to be rectified. Proper placard value should
not get cleared until the respective tyre pressure is be filled after puncture rectification
reaches to the placard value
• If the vehicle is running in an extremely rocky and acute successfully then the corresponding position tyres sensor
bumpy condition then fluctuating pressure leakage alert needs to be checked by carefully opening the tyre
may get set which will get rectified when the vehicle runs
back on a normal road. This happens due to sudden • If the sensor is found to be damaged then it should be
change in pressure levels due to rocky conditions replaced with a new one and manual/auto learning
should be done
Sensor Signal Missing Alert
Sensor Faulty / Low Battery Alert
Each tiretronics sensor in the vehicle tyres has an internal
individual battery . If the battery level is too low or the
When the vehicle runs in sensor by itself is malfunctioning then the Tiretronics
speed above 40kmph, system shall give this alert.
Tiretronics system receives
signal from all the • If the Tiretronics sensor low battery/faulty is set then the
Tiretronics sensor installed corresponding position tyres sensor needs to be
in all running tyres. removed by carefully opening the tyre and replacing it
with a new sensor
• Post replacing the new sensor, manual/auto learning
• On account of any issue in signal reception or Tiretronics should be done
sensor damage or tyres changed with out performing
manual learning then the signal will not be received
• If the Signals from the tiretronics sensor are not received
atleast once, when the vehicle is driven at a speed
greater than 40kmph for more than 10 minutes, "Signal
Missing" alert will be set for the respective tyre and
Tiretronics Telltale will be ON.
• When the Tiretronics signal missing is set then perform
manual learning once. If manual learning is not done
Tyre Auto Learn Process (If Enabled in cluster) blink for 90 sec and remain ON. TPMS indication lamp will
continue until the error condition is rectified.
If spare wheel tyre get swapped with any of the running Refer cluster settings for the “Tyre Fill Assist ” in the”
tyres then display shall show Signal missing in the cluster Instrument Cluster Features” chapter for further details
for respective tyre location and TPMS indication lamp will
within certain value post to each event for learning all Initiating the Manual Learning Process
4 tyres
3. Do not perform Manual learning process at the same
time on two vehicles with in the radius of 20 meters CRUISE
1. Turn the ignition OFF.
4. It is mandatory that manual learning of tyres should SET+ Press and hold the up
follow the sequence of ‘front left tyre position, front SET-
button in steering wheel
right tyre, rear right tyre and rear left tyre. 2. Turn the ignition ON
RESUME
5. It is required to ensure the tyres have pressure >
32psi and < 36psi before initiating the manual
learning process
3. Wait for the cluster’s tachometer and speedometer to
6. Post manual learning, all tyres should be filled to the rotate to highest position and then release the enter button
placard pressure value in up position. Then observe the cluster for the Tiretronics 3
telltale to blink, vehicle siren will indicate by 2 chrips & 2 2
times turn lamps blink and instrument cluster screen shows 1
It is mandatory that manual learning of tyres should follow ‘TPMS MANUAL LEARNING’
the sequence of ‘front left tyre position, front right tyre, rear If failed to enter in to the manual learning mode;
right tyre and rear left tyre.
• Try initiating the manual learning once again
• Check if the reverse gear is engaged, if it is engaged
disengage it
• Check if the Enter button is working fine
If problem still persist, contact an Authorized Mahindra
Dealer for further assistance.
If the front left tyre is learned, 1 siren chirp sound is heard If the rear right tyre is learned, 1 siren chirp sound is heard
and the FL tyre shows learned in the cluster screen. and the RR tyre shows learned in the cluster screen.
If the front right tyre is learned, 1 siren chirp sound is heard If the rear left tyre is learned, 1 siren chirp sound is heard
and the FR tyre shows learned in the cluster screen. and the RL tyre shows learned in the cluster screen.
Limitations
If rear left tyre is also • The Tiretronics monitors only tyre pressure and
learned, then 1 siren chirp temperature. It does not monitor conditions such as tyre
is heard and ALL tyres show wear
learned at respective tyre
positions and ‘All tyres • The Tiretronics will not be able to detect an instant tyre
Learned successfully’ in the burst and inform the driver in advance
centre of the screen. • There may be the possibility of getting all the tyre
location indicators on the Tiretronics display blinking
along with the Tiretronics telltale, on passing
If learning is not successful environment area prone to heavy power lines and RF
at any point of time, or at signal. It will come back to normal condition when
any point of time during the interference gets cleared
learning process if the
learning takes more than 6.32.7 Tiretronics — Points to Remember
90 secs of time for each
tyre position then the • It is recommended to fill the pressure to 32 psi at a digital
system shall exit the gauge station only
learning mode and show
the ‘TPMS Manual Learning • Every 15 days, inflate all the tyres up to 32 psi and
Not Successful’ screen. inflation should be done at cold condition/ambient
temperature
• Pressure deviation between the Tiretronics display and
gauge will depend upon the following factors:
– Atmospheric pressure
– Error in pressure filling gauge (not calibrated)
6.33 Reverse Parking Assist System (RPAS) Do not press or apply shock on the sensors by hitting or using a high-
pressure water gun while washing. The sensors could be damaged.
Reverse parking assistance system is provided to aid the driver
while parking the vehicle in reverse at a speed of less than 8 kmph.
While reversing, RPAS will detect the obstacles at the rear side of 6.33.1 Driving and Operation
the vehicle within the sensing zone, which cannot be viewed
through the internal rear view mirror and the outside rear view
mirrors. The RPAS will alert the driver by sending out sound alarms
at different frequency and display bars in instrument cluster to • RPAS is an aiding system. Under no circumstances
indicate proximity of the obstacle from the vehicle. The alert sound mahindra will accept any responsibility or can be held
level and the number of display bars is proportional to the
distance. Lesser the distance, shorter the interval between beeps & liable for any direct or indirect, incidental or
more number of display bars illuminated. consequential damage caused by this system
• System will not sense pot holes, trenches or drainages
RPAS Sensors which are below the ground level
• Applying paint over the sensor will affect the
performance of the system
Two RPAS sensors are
located at the rear bumper Activation & De-activation of RPAS
to assist driver for hassle- • The vehicle should be in IGN ON state to activate the
free parking. reverse parking assistance system
W62E49
• RPAS will be activated automatically when reverse gear is
engaged and deactivate when reverse gear is disengaged
• When the obstacles come in the sensing range, the
Magnetic devices present in the detection range could vastly affect the systems starts giving the indication based on the distance
sensor performance and the distance displayed may not be accurate. and direction of the obstacles as defined in the detecting
Always keep the sensors clean and free from ice formation, dust, water etc. zones. The closer the obstacles, more display bars
for proper working of the system. illuminate & frequency of beeps increases.
W62S35
following information: the Instrument cluster.
• Left zone indicates
W62S34
obstacle on left side
3. Start moving the vehicle in the reverse direction
W62S36
6.33.3 Operation of RPAS
W62S37
maximum detection range.
W62S39
Dealer
• Obstacle at right at 101 cm
On engaging the gear in reverse, instrument cluster will
display as below:
W62S40
shown in the distance
Lorem ipsum
indicator.
W62S38
reflection condition.
W62E54
• System may give false signal by sensing the ground when the bumper is
tilted more from the normal position or when the vehicle is heavily
overloaded
9. The obstacle of a conical
shape may not be detected, • System may give false signal an alarm during heavy rain, snow and
since the ultrasonic waves heavy wind conditions
get deflected away. • The shape of the obstacle may prevent a sensor from detecting it. Some
obstacles for example as follows:
Blind Zone Obstacle Sensing Zone
– Sharply-angled objects
• System may alert you by sensing the ground when the bumper is not • Because of other ultrasonic sources, sensor may give false alarm for e.
fitted in its intended position or when the vehicle is overloaded g., sweeping machines, high pressure steam cleaners and neon lights
• System may give false signal while the vehicle moves from plain ground • Due to vehicle horns, motorcycle engines, air brakes of large vehicles, or
to a slope terrain and vice versa other loud noises producing ultrasonic waves, the vicinity of the vehicle
is noisy. It may cause sensor to give false alarm
1. Normal View
Rear View Camera is
located under tail gate By selecting Normal View Icon, Rear View
applique. camera provides about 130 deg horizontal
Rear View Camera assists wide rear view of vehicle's rear surrounding on
the driver while reversing & the Infotainment screen.
manoeuvring the Car at
lower speeds. It has the It overcomes limitation of
following features: IRVM, where ground is
visible only after a distance
1. Normal View from vehicle rear. Whereas
with the RVC, the ground
2. Zoom-in View will be visible right after 15
cm to 30 cm from Vehicle’s
3. Full View
Rear
4. Merged Corner View
5. Left Corner View 2. Zoom-In View
Full view is wider than Normal View. Select “Back” Icon to switch to Merged Corner
View.
4. Merged Corner View
By selecting
Merged 6. Right Corner View
Corner Rear
If user wants
View camera
to focus on the
provides a wide view
left side
focussed on the left and
crossing
right corners to provide a
traffic, then "Left Corner
better visibility of crossing
View" icon can be pressed
traffic for safe manouvre.
to select the view.
Merged Corner View shows merged view of rear left and
right corners.
Select “Back” Icon to switch to Merged Corner
View.
Complete Parking
Hold steering in the maximum position and start driving the You cannot enter RVC Mode, through the infotainment
vehicle backwards. when static lines are parallel to target screen button, if the vehicle is in forward/drive gear and
parking slot, bring steering to centre position and continue vehicle speed exceeds 20 kmph.
driving backward until the whole vehicle is in target parking
Exit Conditions
slot. Parking Completed
• If the driver is not in Parallel or Vertical Parking mode and
Infotainment has entered ‘RVC Mode’ by reverse gear
option, then RVC mode exits when reverse gear is
disengaged
• If the driver is not in Parallel or Vertical Parking mode and needs to be taken to the Service Centre. Avoid using the
Infotainment has entered ‘RVC Mode’, due to “Rear View Rear-View Camera under these circumstances.
Camera” selection present on the Infotainment, then RVC
mode can be exited, by selecting the Cancel button • If rear of your vehicle is damaged or if the Camera
appearing on the screen position is changed, please contact the nearest Mahindra
Authorised Service Center immediately.
• Irrespective of RVC entry conditions, when Parallel or
Vertical Parking Mode is active, driver can exit the RVC
Mode using Cancel button that appears, whenever 6.34.4 System Limitations
vehicle is in forward gear
• Rear view camera may not operate normally, when you
• RVC Mode is exited, whenever vehicle is in forward gear drive in the extremely high or low temperature area.
and vehicle speed exceeds 20 kmph. (Operating temperature: -20°C ~ 65°C)
• When ignition is off. • Under certain circumstances given below, the rear view
camera system will work with limitation or will not
function fully:
6.34.3 Camera Maintenance
- In heavy rain, snow or fog.
Always keep the Camera lens clean from dust. Presence of
dirt on lens may lead to poor image quality. - At night or in very dark places.
Always use clear water & soft nonabrasive cloth to clean the - If the camera is exposed to very bright light sources.
lens. - Display may flicker, if the camera area is lit by LED or
fluorescent lighting.
Don’t clean the camera lens and the area around the rear - If there is a sudden change in temperature, from cold to
view camera with a power washer. hot areas.
• In case of any RVC-related issues, the Infotainment - If the camera lens got dirty or obstructed.
displays ‘ Please Contact Service Centre’ and vehicle
• If the rear of your vehicle got damaged. And if the • Objects above the ground or hanged may appear to be
Camera position and the settings got changed. Please far away than they are. But in reality, objects shall be
contact the nearest Mahindra Authorised Service Center closer to your car. In such cases, avoid using guidelines
to judge the distance. Since it leads to mis-adjustments
• Camera image reproduced slightly delayed and not in and increase the risk of collision with your car
real time due to processing. As the display is 2-
dimensional, pointed and protruding obstacles are hard • It is driver’s responsibility to identify the suitable parking
to depict and thus very difficult to recognise. Please avoid area to park car safely
rear view camera in the above situation. It could you
otherwise injure others or damage objects and your • Rear view video is shown, whenever reverse gear is
vehicle applied, but it cannot be used as a rear view monitoring
system, which cannot replace the driver for looking into
• The performance gets affected sometimes due to exterior and interior view mirrors
deposition of ice, dust, heavy rain, heavy wind, heavy
exhaust on the camera
Rear View Camera is only meant to aid the driver and to
enhance convenience while parking. It does not in any way
• Images shown on the display is a mirror-inverted replace the driver’s abilities and driving skills while using
manner, as like the rearview mirror. Make sure that no this system. Under any circumstances, Mahindra accepts no
persons or animals or any objects/materials are in the responsibility and cannot be held liable for any direct or
manoeuvring area. Pay attention and ensure safety indirect, incidental or consequential damage caused by this
before manoeuvring the car. Driver is legally responsible system.
for their car
• The rear view camera is only a supplementary function
and may display obstacles from a distorted perspective
& inaccurately
• Avoid using of rear view camera, if you are having eye
colour blindness or impaired colour vision
7.1 Steering If the power steering system breaks down (or if the engine is
turned OFF or Not availability of vehicle speed / Power cut
Your vehicle is equipped with electric power steering (EPS). off), you can still steer the vehicle manually, but it takes
EPS system provides an external assist, so that the driver more effort.
can easily rotate the steering wheel without much effort. If the steering wanders or pulls, check for:
The power steering system will give you good vehicle
response and increased ease of manoeuvrability in tight • Under inflated tyre(s) on any wheel(s)
spaces. If for some reason the power assist is interrupted, it
will provide mechanical steering capability to steer the • Uneven vehicle loading
vehicle. Under these conditions, you will observe a • High crown in the centre of the road
substantial increase in steering effort, especially at very low
vehicle speeds and during parking manoeuvres. • High crosswinds
• Wheels out of alignment
SET-
RESUME
3
2
1
Steering Audio Operations • Volume Control - Press ‘+’ and ‘- button to increase or
decrease the volume
Infotainment system can be controlled by Steering wheel
switch mounted on the left side of the steering wheel. • Call Connect - Press to accept the incoming call to paired
the BT phone to enable the driver to open the contact list
in infotainment and make the call
A E • Source - Press SOURCE button to toggle between TUNER,
USB, BT AUDIO and MYDRIVE
B + F
VOL
-
SEEK • Seek UP/Down - Press the seek UP/DOWN button can be
C G used for toggling UP/DOWN the menu list of
Infotainment.
H
D
• Call Dis Connect - Press to reject or end active call to the
paired BT phone.
This is provide the flexibility of controlling the infotainment
A: Mute E: Source system while driving without any distraction.
B: Volume + F: SEEK UP
7.3 Cruise Control (if equipped) Cruise control enhances your comfort while
driving and allows you to effortlessly maintain
Cruise control allows you to maintain a set speed without the desired lane speed limit. Improper use of
the need to keep your foot on the accelerator pedal. It the cruise control can lead to an accident.
should be used for cruising on straight, open highways.
Never use it for city driving, inclines, winding roads, slippery
roads, heavy rain or in bad weather conditions. Cruise control is designed to operate above a vehicle speed
It works on the closed loop system principle to maintain the of 20kmph - MT / 35kmph - AT for all gears except 1st and
set speed of the vehicle; the system controls the fuel reverse gears. The cruise lamp in the instrument cluster
injection of the engine in order to maintain the set speed. functions only if the cruise control is active.
Cruise control will function only under the following
conditions;
CRUISE
A CRUISE • The vehicle is cruising above 20kmph - MT / 35kmph - AT
E
+
SET
-
B
+
• Engine RPM above 1200 RPM
RESUME
SET
-
-
RESUME
C
3
2
RESUME
• Clutch pedal released.
1
D
• Brake pedal released.
• Cruise is enabled by pressing ON/OFF button
A CRUISE ON/OFF D CRUISE RESUME
• Cruise is activated first time in an ignition cycle by SET + /
CLUSTER MENU/ SET - button 3
B SET + E
MODE 2
C SET – • 1
Subsequent cruise engagements can be done by RESUME
SET+ /SET- buttons in the same ignition cycle
Cruise control is deactivated under the following If cruise is deactivated (e. g. by depressing brake to handle an
conditions: intervention in the road etc.) in current driving cycle, reactivate the
Cruise to the last active Cruise Speed by pressing the RESUME
• CRUISE OFF button is pressed button.
Cruise control may not hold the set speed when you are going up
• Brake or clutch pedal depressed or down hills, and the vehicle may come out of cruise control. This
is indicated by the cruise lamp going OFF in the instrument cluster.
• If the vehicle speed exceeds the cruise set speed by
20kmph - MT / 35kmph - AT by accelerator pedal
intervention 7.3.2 Cruise Control De-activation
• If vehicle speed is increased by 10 kmph for more than 30 You can cancel cruise control in any of the following ways:
seconds by pressing the accelerator pedal
• Press the CRUISE OFF button in the steering wheel
• When Set +/Set- switch is pressed for more than 12
seconds (In this case, vehicle will not go into cruise mode • Press the brake pedal
in that ignition cycle. In order to restore the cruise
function, switch OFF the ignition, wait for 30 seconds and • Gear selector moved into neutral
switch ON the ignition) • HDC or ESP becomes active
• Cruise influencing error indicated by Check Engine Lamp,
OBD lamp, etc. 7.3.3 SET + Button
7.3.1 Cruise Control Activation SET + button is used to activate cruise control and also to increase
the cruise set speed.
To increase the speed in very small amounts, press the SET +
Cruise is enabled by pressing ON/OFF button button. Each time you press, the cruise set speed increases by
about 2 kmph. When you wish to continuously increase the
Drive the vehicle to the desired cruising speed (any value cruising speed, press and hold the SET + button and release when
greater than 20kmph - MT / 35kmph - AT), press and hold the desired speed is reached.
the SET + button until the cruise lamp in the instrument
cluster illuminates.
7.3.4 SET - Button 1. Assume, you have activated cruise mode and set the
vehicle speed at 50 kmph.
To decrease the speed in small amounts, press the SET -
button. Each time you press, the cruise set speed decreases 2. Due to an obstacle or a sharp turn, you have
by about 2 kmph. When you wish to continuously decrease deactivated the cruise mode either by pressing the
the cruising speed, press and hold the SET- button. When brake pedal or by switching OFF the CRUISE control.
the desired speed is reached, release the button. 3. Vehicle comes out of the cruise mode.
4. When the road condition is suitable to switch over
back to cruise control mode, press RESUME button
If switch is pressed for more than 12 secs., the switch is assumed once. The system activates the cruise control mode to
to be malfunctioning and the cruise functionality ceases to
function in that ignition cycle. To resume functionality, ignition has the previous cruising speed of 50 kmph.
to toggled. 5. To resume the previous cruise set speed, the vehicle
speed should be above 20kmph - MT / 35kmph - AT.
7.4 Advanced Driver Assistance System (If 5 Lane Keep Assist System (LKA/LDW)
equipped)
6 Smart Pilot Assist (SPA)
The Advance Driver Assist System (ADAS) uses camera and
radar to provide alerts and controls to improve the overall
safety and increase the driver comfort. It should be noted In view of the policy of continuously improving our
that ADAS is only an assistance given to the driver; it neither products, we reserve the right to alter specifications or
replaces the driver nor is a substitute. designs without prior notice and without liability/obligation.
Illustrations do not show the vehicle in the standard form.
Please be aware that this manual may apply to various
The ADAS system gives models/variants. As a result you may find some
ADAS enormous benefits to explanations for equipment not installed on your vehicle. All
DISPLAY
driver, however the driver the information, illustration, and specifications in this
shall remain solely manual are based on the latest product information
responsible for the safe
CRUISE
RESUME
START
CRUISE
ADAS
RESUME
SWITCHES
throughout the drive. Mahindra Dealer for latest features applicable to your
vehicle.
3
2
1
7.4.1 Maintenance Guidelines for Camera and • If the windshield portion in front of camera has any
Radar Sensor cracks/scratches/stone chips, it should be taken to
Mahindra Service Centre for complete windshield
replacement.
Front Camera Camera Maintenance • If the vehicle met with any accident or impact, particularly
Module (ADAS)
To avoid incorrect, partial for the front side, contact Mahindra Service Centre to
or disabled ADAS check for any damage / calibration errors in the Camera.
functionality due to Camera • In case any modification to be done for Camera, beauty
sensor failure, following cover, Inside Rear View Mirror or Ceiling, contact
Front Radar points to be taken care of. Mahindra Service Centre.
Module
• ACC has limited braking capability and may not stop the 7.5.1 ACC Switches
vehicle in time to avoid a collision, if the front preceding
vehicle decelerates quickly or a new vehicle cuts-in front
always be prepared to apply brake.
A CRUISE
• Failure to follow the alerts and instructions for proper The ACC switches on the
B
use of system could result in serious injury. SET+ steering wheel consists of
C
five switches which are
• Always observe posted speed limits and do not set the SET-
E
• Use ACC in appropriate roads with proper lane marking
and sign boards.
• Do not use ACC in busy areas where multiple road users A - CRUISE ON/OFF Switch
cross the vehicles intended path.
• To Toggle between ACC ON and OFF 3
• When two wheeler cuts out, ACC may not be able to B - SET+ 2
identify the vehicle in front of two-wheeler. 1
• To set desired speed
• ACC may not be able to stop behind stopped vehicles.
• To increase Set speed when ACC is active
• ACC may not be always able to follow two wheeler.
C - TIME GAP
• To select the time gap to the front preceding vehicle
ACC may not detect all types of vehicle and driver has to be between Level 4 to Level 1.
vigilant to be in control of the vehicle.
D - SET-
• To set desired speed
• To decrease Set speed when ACC is active
E - RESUME
• To resume ACC to previous Set Speed. front preceding vehicle Indicator shows an icon of a Car
always though the front preceding vehicle may be a car/
truck/two wheeler or any other type of vehicle.
Do not use RESUME button to Set Speed immediate after
ACC ON. Do use only SET+/SET- 7.5.3 How to turn ACC ON/OFF
Pressing the ON/OFF switch when ACC in Standby/Active will ACC indicator will be displayed in green.
deactivate the ACC feature. • Set speed will be displayed as set by driver.
• Time interval bars will be displayed.
2. Follow Control Mode • When there is a front preceding vehicle, user can set
desired speed by pressing SET+/- switch below 30 kmph
as there is no minimum desired speed requirement
During Follow Mode, front preceding vehicle Indicator will • When front preceding vehicle and your vehicle are in
be displayed if a front preceding vehicle is detected. stopped condition , apply brake and press SET +/SET-.
Note that ACC will remain in standstill until the front
ACC operation When Front Preceding Vehicle detected preceding vehicle moves.
ahead
When there is a preceding vehicle, ACC tries to maintain a
safe gap to the front preceding vehicle by reducing the When the SET +/SET– switch is pressed under the following
speed accordingly within comfortable deceleration limits. conditions, ACC cannot be activated. Visual and audio alert
will be provided to driver to inform the same.
ACC operation When Front Preceding Vehicle moved out
from its lane
When the front preceding vehicle has moved out from your lane of travel,
ACC accelerates and maintains vehicle speed to the set speed.
W62E162
Lorem ipsum Lorem ipsum
W62E159
W62E163
Lorem ipsum
When the brakes are operated by
the driver
W62E164
Lorem ipsum
Lorem ipsum
Condition Alert • Press and quickly release the SET- switch to decrease the
set speed by 1 kmph
• Press and hold the SET- switch to decrease the set speed.
When driver seat belt is not by 10 kmph. The set speed will be decreased to the next
buckled. nearest multiple of 10
W62E165
Lorem ipsum
Lorem ipsum
• Release the switch when the desired set speed reached.
How to resume ACC to last set speed value
ACC interacts with other systems, such as braking, steering, EMS
(Engine Management System), ACC Switch etc. If any of these Press the RESUME switch
systems are not functioning properly, ACC cannot be activated.
– ACC will resume back to the last set speed provided the
How to increase Set Speed conditions to engage ACC are satisfied.
Use one of the following methods to increase set speed: How to change the Time Gap Level to the front
preceding vehicle
• Press and quickly release the SET+ switch to increase the
set speed by 1 kmph Each time the Time gap switch C is pressed, the time gap will keep
rolling between the time gap levels as per the below sequence
• Press and hold the SET+ switch to increase the set speed
by 10 kmph. The set speed will be increased to the next Time Gap Level 4->Time Gap Level 3 -> Time Gap Level 2->
nearest multiple of 10. Continuous hold / stuck of SET +/-
button for 60 sec will turn OFF ACC. Time Gap Level 1-> Time Gap Level 4
ON/OFF
SET+
SET-
RESUME
3
2
1
W62D58
ACC STOP & GO (Only for EPB Variants) ACC can be engaged by any of the following methods when
in stop-hold mode if front preceding vehicle is present at
ACC operation When front preceding vehicle is detected distance more than 2m and less than 40m:
in models equipped with Electronic Park Brake
1. Press RESUME button
When a front preceding vehicle is detected, front preceding
vehicle indicator along with time interval bars will be 2. Slightly tap the accelerator pedal
displayed in cluster
3. Increase the speed above 10 kmph and press the
In slow-moving, stop-and-go traffic or when stopped at a RESUME button
traffic light, if the front preceding vehicle comes to stop, ACC
decelerates to bring your vehicle also to stop within the
limitations of the system. Your vehicle movement will When in ACC stopped condition, if driver is trying to
resume automatically if the front preceding vehicle is not unbuckle seat belt/open doors/ change gear etc, then ACC
stopped for more than approx. 3 seconds. may get disengaged and based on gear lever position,
vehicle may crawl. Driver has to apply brake and control the
vehicle.
If it takes more than 3
seconds for the front ACC without Stop & Go
preceding vehicle to begin
moving again, ACC will be For vehicles with manual parking brake, ACC without STOP
set to Standby and the & GO is applicable. Here, If the front preceding vehicle
stop-hold function will comes to stop, ACC decelerates to bring the vehicle speed
activate. A pop-up alert up to 20 kmph and disengages. System provides pop up
message “Press Resume message “Adaptive Cruise Control Standby” for driver to
W62E166
Lorem ipsum
Lorem ipsum Switch or Pedal to take necessary action.
Accelerate” will be
displayed for driver to
resume. ACC decelerates when there is too much of lateral
acceleration.
W62E167
Lorem ipsum followed
Lorem ipsum message will be displayed
as “Object Disappeared
Pay Attention”
Please pay attention to the driving operation to maintain • ACC override pop-up will
control of the vehicle as it accelerates to the set speed. be displayed.
W62E170
• When accelerator pedal is depressed for more than 60 Lorem ipsum
released/disengaged.
Lorem ipsum
seconds continuously.
• When collision mitigation system is in action.
• When ESP operates The driver is responsible for adapting to vehicle's speed,
apply the brakes when necessary and keep a safe distance
• When driver door is open to the vehicle ahead.
• When vehicle speed exceeds maximum ACC operating
speed.
ACC disengages whenever there is an ESP intervention. For
• When driver seat belt is unbuckled example-: pot holes on a bumpy road
• When the Zoom mode is selected.
W62E168
Lorem ipsum up message will be given in
Lorem ipsum No action possible. Heavy
the instrument cluster
"Collision Possible Apply Heavy rain or snow is precipitation may affect the
Brake". interfering with the radar function of the radar.
The driver has to apply brake to keep a safe distance. signals. Do not use ACC during
heavy rain or snow.
No action possible. A very
Clogged water or snow wet or snow-covered road
from the surface of the surface may affect the
In case of temporary
road may interface with the function of the radar.
abnormal conditions, ACC
radar signals. Do not use ACC during
Status telltale will
illuminate in Yellow color these situations.
and ACC function will be The bumper area in front Wait a short time. It may
disabled temporarily by of the radar is clean but the take several minutes for the
showing up a pop-up message remains in the radar to detect that it is no
display. longer obstructed.
“Adaptive Cruise Control Disabled due to Radar Limitation”
• When traffic conditions make it difficult to keep a proper • Situation of stopped vehicles
distance between vehicles because of frequent
acceleration or deceleration
• Interference by other radar sources installed in nearby
protected areas like military, airports etc.
• Do not use Adaptive Cruise Control in demanding driving
conditions, in slippery conditions, when there is a great
deal of water or slush on the road, during heavy rain or
snow, in poor visibility, on winding roads or on highway
on or off ramps. Sudden vicinity of stationary object in host vehicle's lane
may not be detected.
ACC Limitation Scenarios
ACC may not function in below scenarios
• Close cut-in situation
At this time, since there is no collision with Vehicle-A, the In the curve entry / exit situation, based on the curvature of
driver may misunderstand that it is under normal control of road on which the host vehicle is moving differs from the
Vehicle-A. curvature of the predicted road, so the adjacent lane can be
selected as the control target and the preceding vehicle in
When Vehicle-B starts, host vehicle may start without the host lane may be missed
considering the new stationary Vehicle-A because of
irregular radar reflection. • Curves with larger curvature
• Curve entry / exit situation
In case of poor visibility, Driver must take the control of In case of road gradient variation, preceding target vehicle
vehicle may be lost and ACC may not function as intended. Driver
must take the control of vehicle.
• When a preceding vehicle enters an intersection
• Sensor cover blockage
In an road intersection, target preceding vehicle may be lost Any blockage to sensors, detection will degrade and ADAS
and ACC may not function as intended. Driver must take the features may not function as intended
control of vehicle.
If the preceding vehicle brakes beyond the ACC maximum front preceding vehicle. Visit nearest service center for
deceleration limit, AEB may engage. However, driver shall be radar alignment
alert and take control vehicle.
• ACC does not slowdown for pot-holes and Speed
• Detection performance deterioration due to road breakers
side structures
W62D70
• ACC may not slow down for road curves • ACC does not slow down for crossing or merging
vehicles at angles more than 30 degree
W62D81
W62D83
• ACC may not slow down for barriers/blockades
W62D84
W62D74
ACC might not slow down your XUV700 sufficiently if target starts to • ACC may not reliably follow bicycle
decelerate too fast as ACC only has only 30% of total brakeforce available in
vehicle
W62D73
W62D79
W62D80
• If a target in front takes a sharp turn and goes out of • ACC cannot follow a motorized two-wheeler if two-
Field of view, then your XUV700 can start to accelerate wheeler speed is less than around 10kmph.
fast.
• Do not use ACC with an offset to the target vehicle.
• ACC might not pick-up target at sharp curve
W62D87
W62D82
• Do not use ACC to follow motorbikes where there is no
• When XUV700 follows two wheeler and two wheeler space for XUV700 to navigate.
overtakes stationary target ahead, XUV700 may not slow
down due to stationary target detection limitation.
W62D89
W62D88
7.6 Collision Mitigation System • System does not function in all driving, traffic, weather
and road conditions.
Collision Mitigation System alerts the driver by providing
audio and visual warning when there is a possibility of • System does not detect all kind of vehicles ,bicyclists and
collision with rear end of the preceding vehicles, cyclists or pedestrians.
pedestrians detected ahead. if driver fails to take actions • System is designed to intervene as late as possible i.e. in
within a rational time, system will apply braking in certain emergency to help avoid unnecessary activation.
situations to mitigate the collision.
• Vehicles, Pedestrians or cyclists at an offset may not be
Disclaimer detected by FCW/AEB system.
• System can detect vehicles, cyclists and pedestrians but • Collision Mitigation System works on prediction of
not in all situations. System's capacity to assess certain possible collision with the objects in front of vehicle by
traffic situations is a supplemental aid to the driver and assuming the objects movements in certain directions.
does not function in all driving/traffic situations or Sometimes the objects movement direction may not
weather/road conditions. It can never replace the driver’s match to the prediction and the system may react early
attention to traffic conditions or his/her responsibility for and provide warning or perform braking even though the
operating the vehicle in a safe manner. Refer system object may not be in the host vehicle path.
limitation section for more information about system
limitation. Read the manual carefully in detail before • Only rear end of the preceding vehicles are identified by
using the system. the system and warning or braking as needed will be
provided by the system. System may not react or
• Failure to follow the warnings and instructions for proper providing warning or braking for a crossing or oncoming
use of the system could result in serious injury or death. vehicle. System may not react to a stationary vehicle if
• The Collision Mitigation System is a supplemental aid to the vehicle is stationed in crossing or oncoming pose.
the driver . It is not a replacement for the driver. It is
driver's responsibility to monitor traffic conditions and
drive the vehicle safely. It cannot prevent accidents due
to carelessness or dangerous driving techniques.
Level 3 Warning
The icon displayed as visual alert may show the object in
the front as car even though the system may react for cars,
pedestrians,two wheelers and cyclists. • After second level
warning, If the driver
does not take action or
driver braking force is
not enough and risk of a
collision is imminent, the
system applies harder
braking along with third
W62E63 level of visual and
audible warning.
and cannot completely avoid the collision. The driver is • Select “Forward Collision Warning” and use the OK
responsible for maintaining a safe distance and speed. button to turn the FCW system on
Never wait for a warning or collision mitigation system to
take action. • Select “Off” and use the OK button to turn the AEB/
FCW system off
1. In case of temporarily abnormal conditions • If the warning lamp continues to illuminate after above
due to camera sensor, AEB warning lamp will action and engine restart, have the system checked. It is
be ON in yellow color and a pop up message recommended that you visit a Mahindra dealer for this
will appear in instrument cluster that "Automatic Emergency service.
Braking Function Limited due to Camera Blockage" .
2. In case of temporarily abnormal conditions
due to radar sensor, AEB warning lamp will be
ON in yellow color and a pop up message will
appear in instrument cluster that "Automatic Emergency
The following table lists Braking Disabled due to Radar Detection Limitation".
possible causes for this
message being displayed
and suitable actions:
– Pedestrians other than their walking or standing – Two wheeler carrying baggage extended beyond
poses may not be detected. regular shape of two wheeler.
– Pedestrians in wheelchairs or using mobile transport – Obscured vehicles.
such as scooters, child-operated toys, or skateboards
• If the pedestrians has limited contrast to their immediate
– Pedestrians who are seated or otherwise not in a full background, warning or braking may be delayed or not
upright standing or walking position come at all.
– Pedestrian who are partially obscured, wearing • System may not react for fast moving pedestrians.
clothing that prevents a clear view of the person's
body contours. • System cannot detect all cyclists in all situations, such as:
• When any vehicle moves greater than +/- 20 deg. to Due to poor visibility by camera like sunlight or any other
host vehicle direction source of light on camera. System may not function as
intended Driver must be alert and take control of the vehicle
• When the tail light of the front preceding vehicle is
asymmetrical at night
• Pedestrian suddenly jumping in to the host vehicle In the case of pedestrians whose body part is obscured by
lane too closer to host vehicle umbrellas, bags, special clothes, etc., detection may not be
accurate & system may not function as intended. Driver
shall be alert and take control of vehicle
• Difficult to distinguish pedestrians due to low
illumination.
The control target of the radar is selected as the control Due to the vertical angle limit of the radar, it is impossible to
target only for the rear surface of the vehicle driving in the detect the front target (vehicle, pedestrian) in uphill and
AEB vehicle driving direction. Therefore, there is a risk of downhill hill.
collision for vehicles moving at right angles to the direction
of intersection or for vehicles turning right. • The situation where the load is protruding from the
rear of the vehicle
When a specific type of load is loaded or a special vehicle, it • When driving on a large curve road
can collide if it is not selected as the control target due to
the sensor detection limit
• When target can not be detected due to sensor
contamination
If the driver uses the AEB in the unconfined (snow, rain, fog, • Collision Mitigation System does not react for pot-holes
etc.), the sensor limit may cause a collision between the
vehicle and pedestrians ahead.
• Detection problems due to complicated structures
around roads
W62D70
W62D71
• Collision Mitigation System does not function for • Collision Mitigation System does not function for animals
barricades/cone/barrels
W62D72
W62D74
• Collision Mitigation System does not function for 7.7 High Beam Assist
oncoming vehicles
High beam assist function is intended to reduce the glare
produced by the High Beam lamp which in turn aids the
drivers of oncoming vehicles to maneuver safely .
High beam assist feature automatically turns high beam ON
or OFF depending on the vehicle speed, intensity of the light
source of preceding and oncoming vehicles and the
surrounding light conditions
W62D79
How to Turn ON/OFF HBA System Turn Steering Column Head lamp Switch to 'AUTO' position
HBA Activation
Select High Beam Assist function from Driver assistance
menu
+
SET
-
RESUME
VOL +
+
menu
-
RESUME
3
• Auto light switch is turned ON in the Combination Switch
2
1
• Night condition is detected and Low beam is already
turned ON through the Light Sensor
• High beam switch is turned ON
• Vehicle speed is above 20 kmph
Once HBA is activated, HBA feature will turn OFF High Beam
when any of the light sources from oncoming / Preceding
vehicle or streetlights is detected in front of vehicle.
HBA feature will turn ON High Beam when: 7.7.1 HBA System Limitations
• HBA function is activated as per above conditions. HBA is subject to certain system limitations and may keep
• No light source is detected by the camera from High beam OFF for certain limitations and ON for few other
Oncoming/Preceding vehicle or from other light sources limitation conditions.
(depends on intensity) for few seconds. • When the light from the on-coming or front preceding
vehicle is not detected because of lamp damage, hidden
from sight, etc.
If high beam was turned OFF due to street lights, then high
beam will be turned ON once streetlight area is completely • When headlights or taillights are with non-standard color
crossed or Illuminance level or shape.
• When the lamp of the on-coming or front preceding
vehicle is covered with dust, mud, snow or water.
If system malfunctions , a pop up message will appear in • When visibility is poor due to fog, heavy rain or snow.
Instrument Cluster as "High Beam Assist Unavailable". It is
recommended that you visit a Mahindra dealer in this case. • When head lamp aiming is not properly adjusted.
• When driving on a narrow-curved road or rough road.
• When driving downhill or uphill.
• When vehicle is near bright street tower lamps, reflecting
sign or mirror, flashing sign lamps.
• When the vehicle is tilted may be due to a flat tyre or
being towed.
• When the light from bicycle is weak or located in long
distance.
• When the light from oncoming or preceding vehicle is 7.8 Traffic Sign Recognition
very small or weak or located in low or too high position.
Traffic Sign Recognition feature assists the driver by
• When windshield is dirty or if any object blocks the displaying Speed limits signs in the instrument cluster
Camera sensor. display.
• When vehicle is in Construction area due to temporarily
installed reflectors.
• When vehicle is near traffic lights, signboards of TSR system is limited to the detection capabilities of Camera
buildings, lightning rods of construction sections, center sensor . The driver is always responsible for operating the
line separation rods (reflection type), traffic signs vehicle as per the road regulations.
(including variable speed LEDs), vehicle lights reflected on
building glass or road reflectors.
Traffic sign recognition can detect standard speed limit
signs that are within the camera's visual field.
How to Turn ON/OFF TSR System
Select Traffic Sign Recognition Function from Driver
Assistance menu in the cluster
CRUISE
VOL + +
SET
-
RESUME
+
VOL +
RESUME
START
ENGINE
STOP
3
2
1
REAR
A/C ECON
A/C
NO OFF
Traffic sign display in Instrument Cluster If no new Speed Limit Sign detected for some time,
the icon changes to 'No Recognition’ as shown in the
Speed: limit Signs image.
• Another vehicle blocks the traffic sign. 7.9 Lane Keep Assist System
• The LED light of the traffic sign is broken. The Lane Keep Assist (LKA) system provides corrective
• The visibility is poor due to heavy rain, snow, fog or poor steering to prevent the vehicle from departing the lane if the
light around the sign. system judges that the departure is unintentional from
driver's side.
• The traffic sign do not conform to the standards.
The Lane Departure Warning (LDW) system provides visual,
• The traffic sign cannot be distinguished due to shadow audio and haptic alerts to the driver once the system
caused by overpass or trees. detects that the vehicle is crossing the lane boundary
unintentionally which is determined based on whether the
• There is bright light around the traffic sign.
turn signal towards the direction of departure is turned ON
• The vehicle speed is too low or too high. or not.
• There is dirt, ice or frost on the front windshield, where The driver can choose to have either Warning Only or both
the camera is installed. Warning + Assist feature.
• The camera lens is blocked by an object, such as sticker, It is important to know that the Lane keep Assist system
paper, or fallen leaf. shall work only if the lane markings on the road are clearly
visible.
• Host vehicle driven right after preceding vehicle.
• The bus or truck, on which the speed sticker is attached,
passes by your vehicle. The Lane Keep Assist function is meant to provide assist to
the driver and cannot take full control of the steering
• TSR function may not detect electronic sign board.
system.
• TSR function may not detect conditional sign board. It is driver’s responsibility to stay alert and be in control of
• TSR function may not detect rectangular sign boards. the vehicle throughout the drive.
When vehicle approaches either the left or the LKA Operation in "Warning + Assist" mode
right lane boundary, the LDW indicator on the
instrument panel will blink and lane marking If both side lanes are not detected or the speed
color of respective side will change to orange. Haptic and /road/vehicle dynamic conditions are not
audio alert will also be provided to warn the driver about satisfied, LKA feature will be in STANDBY mode
lane departure. and LKA indicator light will illuminate in white.
The warning will be stopped either when vehicle changes If both lane markers are detected, vehicle
the lane completely or if the vehicle returns back to original speed is above 60 kmph and all the road and
lane. vehicle related activation conditions are
satisfied, LKA system is ready to provide assist
and LKA indicator light will illuminate in green.
Lane Departure Warning will not be provided or stopped if When the system detects an unintentional
already being provided, if in case either turn signal or departure of the vehicle from its lane, a slight
hazard switch is turned ON counter steering torque is provided to prevent
Lane departure warning shall be resumed in approximately the departure and the driver is notified by
4 seconds after turning OFF the turn signal. blinking the LKA indicator on the instrument panel in green
color. Also visual and audible alerts are provided if vehicle is
Lane Departure Warning may be provided for road edges or about to cross the lane boundary.
road marks which looks like lane boundaries.
The maximum warning time is limited to 2.2 sec. To provide The warning and assist will be stopped either when vehicle
re-warning, vehicle should have been out of warning region changes the lane completely or if the vehicle is returned
atleast once. i.e. Vehicle has to be in or near to center of the back to original lane
lane. When LKA system provides steering assist,
START
VOL +
SET+
SET-
RESUME
ENTER
Lane Keep Assist will not be provided or stopped if already The audible alert can be disabled through settings in the
being provided, if in case either turn indicator signal or cluster if the driver wishes to do so.
hazard switch is turned ON.
Lane Keep Assist shall be resumed again only once vehicle
has returned back to lane and 4 seconds is completed after LKA and LDW shall be activated above 60 kmph and gets
turning OFF the turn indicator signal. deactivated below 55 kmph.
LKA may be provided for road markings if those are looking If the vehicle dynamics conditions are not safe for the
like lane boundaries. LKA may be provided for road edges/ operation of LKA, then LKA may not be provided at all or
vertical road edges (cones/curbs/medians/guard rails) if the may get cancelled if it is already being provided.
system detects them accurately, but not always guaranteed.
Similarly when Left turn /Right turn/Hazard is activated LKA
will not be provided or will be cancelled if already being
provided.
LKA will not be provided if the vehicle approaches the lane The Lane Keep Assist torque will be adjusted according to
boundary with a higher heading angle. the driver applied torque to reduce discomfort and to
provide precedence to driver control.
If the driver intentionally tries to cross the lane boundary by
LKA won’t be provided in the types of roads if road edge/ applying more torque, then assist will be cancelled. In such
vertical road edge is present on one side and neither road conditions warning alone will be provided once the vehicle
edge/vertical road edge nor lane marking is present on the crosses the lane boundary.
other side.
7.9.1 Lane Keep Assist System Limitations • Poor visibility due to sun glare or blockage in lens
• Lane Keep assist function will be disabled when the
LKA and LDW System is intended to assist the driver and trailer is attached.
cannot function as intended in all kinds of driving, weather,
traffic and road conditions as mentioned below. • Lane Keep assist functions will not work properly when
there is a heavy cross wind.
• Road under construction
• Lane Keep assist function may not work when the lane
• Reduced visibility due to bad weather on account of rain, marking color is other than white and yellow.
fog, snow etc
In such situations, it may be advisable to turn the function
• Roads with indistinct/faded lane markings OFF or driver shall take complete control of vehicle.
7.10 Smart Pilot Assist System an increased risk of collision with surrounding obstacles
that are not detected by the system.
Smart Pilot Assist system is intended to help the driver to
keep the vehicle in center of a traffic lane's side marker lines How to activate Smart Pilot Assist
by providing steering assist as well as maintaining a set time Select "Smart Pilot Assist" from "Driver Assistance" option in
interval. Instrument Cluster screen -> under Instrument Cluster
Settings.
SET-
RESUME
ENTER
wheel indicator will illuminate in green. If lane centering was active and road is straight, Smart Pilot
If system was assisting and transiting to Assist may be provided for some more time even though
Standby due to any reasons, then Smart Pilot Assist will stop lane markings are not available.
providing assist and indicator light will blink in white for few Smart Pilot Assist may follow preceding vehicle if lanes are
seconds not detected properly and following conditions are satisfied.
If a slower moving vehicle is detected ahead during lane • Lane centering was active before lane detection got
centering, the system will reduce the vehicle speed so that dropped.
your vehicle follows the vehicle in front as per the set time
gap. • Preceding vehicle speed is less than around 75 kmph
When lane markings are not available, system will follow set • Preceding vehicle is close enough for system to follow.
speed and set time gap as set by the driver for ACC. Smart Pilot Assist may stop to follow preceding vehicle if
above conditions are not satisfied or if the preceding
vehicle has changed the path.
Hands-off Detection & Warning : When driver does not
hold the steering wheel with adequate torque, Smart Pilot
First stage warning will be • In some rare situations when system is unable to do
provided immediately once proper judgement, system may generate visual / audio
hands off is detected alerts even when the driver holds the steering wheel as a
precautionary measure.
• When interface systems are not available. 7.10.1 Smart Pilot Assist System Limitations
• When driver steers manually. Smart Pilot Assist is subject to certain system limitations and
• When vehicle dynamics/road conditions are not suitable may be unavailable or only partially available in the
for Smart Pilot Assist Operation. following situations:
When Smart Pilot Assist cancels, the Smart Pilot Assist Failure to operate the vehicle in accordance with below
indicator changes to White color to indicate that system is system limitations could result in serious injury or death.
no longer active.
Note: All the limitations of ACC also apply for Smart
Pilot Assist.
• Smart Pilot Assist is unable to accurately determine lane
When there is
markings due to poor visibility (heavy rain, snow, fog,
any failure in the etc.), or an obstructed, covered, or damaged camera or
system , below sensor.
pop-up message
appears on Instrument Cluster • When driving on hills.
screen and Smart Pilot Assist
indicator illuminate in Amber • The road has sharp curves or is excessively rough.
color. Visit nearest Mahindra
service center for assistance. • Bright light (such as direct sunlight) is interfering with the
camera's view.
• The sensors are affected by other electrical equipment or
devices that generate ultrasonic waves.
• When driving on winding or uneven roads.
• When there is a lane closure due to road repairs.
• When driving in a makeshift or temporary lane.
• When driving on roads where the lane width is too deactivated state if lanes are not available on both sides or
narrow. if lane is available only on one side.
• On roads where there are multiple parallel lane markers;
lane markers that are faded or not painted clearly; non-
standard lane markers; or lane markers covered with
water, dirt, snow, etc.
• On roads where the discontinued lane markers are still
detectable.
• On roads where the traveling lane merges or separates.
W62D75
• When the vehicle’s traveling direction does not align with
the lane marker.
• When the headlights are not bright due to dirt on the lens
or if the aiming is not adjusted properly.
• Smart Pilot Assist function will not work properly when
there is a heavy cross wind.
• Smart Pilot Assist function may not work when the lane
marking color is other than white or yellow on both the W62D76
sides of the road.
W62D77
W62D78
8.1 Control Switches Power windows can be operated when the ignition is in
“ON” position.
The driver can operate all the power windows in the vehicle
A C E G through the Driver door window switch on the driver door
The driver door switch bank armrest/handle.
is located on the driver
door armrest/handle and
controls and the various
B D F H
functions:
If you operate the switches often during a short period of 8.1.3 Door Lock/Unlock Switch
time, the system might become inoperable for a certain
duration to prevent damage due to overheating. The system
will return to normal functioning shortly. In such scenario, The Door lock/unlock
customer should wait for 1-2 minute & should not operate switch is located on the
the switch during this period. After 2 minute operate the driver door trim. Driver can
switch. simultaneously lock/unlock
It is recommended to operate one window switch at a time. all the doors by pressing
this switch as shown in the
To avoid any personal injuries always check and ensure that image.
there are no obstructions like head, hand, etc. while
operating the 'power windows'.
8.1.2 Power Window Lock Switch 8.1.4 Smart Power Window with Anti-Pinch
The main power window quadruple switch in the driver This is applicable for driver door only (if equipped)
door trim has a power window lock switch to enable or Smart power window is one of the significant safety features
disable operation of rear passenger window switches. with the anti-pinch function, which automatically reverses
the direction of glass if an obstruction is detected during the
auto up mode.
To disable the rear
passenger power windows,
press the window lock
switch down.
To revert to normal
operation, press the
window lock switch again.
W62G160
REAR
A/C ECON
A/C
NO OFF
NO OFF
Press the lid to release the latch and lower the holder. It is
DO NOT overstretch the luggage net. ALWAYS keep your face strategically positioned to be accessed easily by both the
and body out of the luggage net’s recoil path. DO NOT use driver and front passenger.
the luggage net when the strap has visible signs of wear or
damage.
Do not access the sunglass holder while you are driving. It
may distract your concentration and could lead to an
accident.
RESUME
START
ENGINE
STOP
3
2
1
REAR
A/C ECON
A/C
The Second Row 60P seat features an armrest with cup holder.
8.3.6 Bottle and Umbrella Holder To avoid injury, do not place large or hard objects in the seat
back pockets. Do not put more than 1 kg weight in seat back
pockets.
Bottle and Umbrella
holders are located on both
Bottle Holder the front door lower trims. 8.3.8 Grip Handle and Coat Hook
You can use them to store
Umbrella Holder umbrella, maps, papers, Grip Handle: Foldable grip handles are provided above the front
(passenger only) and second and Third row outboard seats.
small books, bottles, etc.
Coat Hook: The second-row outboard passenger seats grip
handles features a coat hook for hanging your coat, shirts, etc.
The microphone is located on the roof above driver side as shown RESUME
in the image.
To shield the sunlight
through the side window,
pull it downward, unsnap it
from the bracket and swing
SOS
it to the side.
Adjusting the sun visor or using the mirror on the sun visor while
The microphone is used when talking on the phone. The person
driving may cause an accident by taking your attention away or
you are speaking to can be heard from the front speakers.
blocking your view
Adjust and use the sun visor when the vehicle is not in moving
To use the hands-free system, you must pair your Bluetooth® phone
to the system.
8.5.1 Vanity Mirror and Lamp (if equipped) 8.6 Center Fascia Switch
Vanity mirror is in the Sun visor. Center fascia switches are located at the center of the
Instrument Panel.
There are three types of center fascia switches available
Swing the sun visor down based on the variants.
and slide the cover to open
and close the vanity mirror.
DRIVE
ON OFF OFF MODE
A B C D E F G
Lamp above the sun visor
will be ON once you slide
and open the vanity mirror.
DRIVE
ON OFF OFF MODE
Type 1 Type 2
A B C D E F G
A B C D
A: LH - USB Port
1
0
The power sockets function only when the ignition is in ACC To prevent injuries and accidents, secure all electrical
or ON positions. It is recommended to use the power appliances before use. Do not use any appliance that may:
sockets when the engine is ON to avoid battery drain.
• Distract the driver while driving, or hamper safe driving
• Result in a fire or burn injuries due to the appliance
To avoid serious injury: rolling, falling or overheating
• Close the power outlet cap when not in use • Emit steam, while the windows of the passenger
compartment are closed
• Do not allow children to use or play with the power
outlet
• When using electrical appliances, strictly follow the • Use the power outlets only when the engine is running.
manufacturer's instruction manual Remove the plug from the power outlet after using the
electric device. Using the power outlets when the engine
• Never use the power outlet for electric heaters while is OFF or leaving the electric device plugged in for many
sleeping
hours may cause the battery to drain
• Never insert foreign objects into the power outlet • Do not use the power outlet to connect electric
• Never use malfunctioning electrical appliances accessories or equipment that are not designed to
operate on 12V
• Never insert inappropriate or badly fitting plugs into the
power outlet • Some electronic devices can cause electronic interference
when plugged into the power outlet. These devices may
Do not modify, disassemble or repair the power outlet in cause excessive audio noise and may interfere with other
any way. Doing so may result in unexpected malfunction or electronic systems or devices in your vehicle
fire, which could cause serious damage to equipment and/
or personal injuries. Contact an Authorised Mahindra
Dealer for any necessary repairs.
8.9 Wireless Mobile Charging (If equipped) manufacturer to check whether your smartphone supports
DRIVE
QI wireless charging.
NO OFF OFF MODE
A wireless mobile charging Recommended to place the phone on the center of the
unit is located in front of charger’s pad to start charging
the center console below Before charging remove the phone cover/case to improve
the front USB ports. charging efficiency
The wireless charging will work in ignition ON, Cranking and If any metallic object such as coins is placed between the wireless
Engine ON conditions only. It will not work when the vehicle charger and the smartphone, the charging will be stopped & a
warning “Foreign object detected’ will be displayed on the cluster.
is in accessory mode or in ignition OFF condition. Kindly remove the coin or the metallic object. This is done to stop
Follow the below steps to charging mobile in wireless heating of the metallic object which might hurt the driver or the
passengers.
mobile charger.
Do not place misalign your phone from the charging pad. It may
To start wireless charging, place the smartphone equipped not charge or give a warning on the cluster.
with wireless charging function on the wireless charging pad Do not place any smart key on the charging pad.
and turn the ignition ON
Keep the charging pad clean and dry.
For best wireless charging results, place the smartphone in Do not keep any Debit/Credit card between the phone & the
the center of the charging pad. Phone charging indication charger. It may damage the card. A warning is displayed on the
will appear on the IVI screen. cluster for the same.
A C
B D
A Media / Menu
B Favourite
C Home / Back
Event
S.No Button Type Event Action
5 Double Open App drawer
Press
Down Short Move the Point of focus to DOWN by 1 item
Long Move the Point of focus to DOWN by 1 item continuously until the press
Press
Double Open Quick Application Drawer in infotainment screen.
Press
OK/Power In Power On mode, select current items in Point of Focus
Short
In Power Off mode, toggle System On/Off
Long Toggle System On/Off
Scroll Knob Increase volume of current Audio functionality by as many steps in case of
(When Clicks, clockwise direction
controlling Direction Decrease volume of current Audio functionality by as many steps in case of
Volume) Rotary counter clockwise direction
Scroll Knob Knob Move Point of Focus to the right/down by as many counts in case of
(When Clicks, clockwise direction
controlling Direction Move Point of Focus to the left/up by as many counts in case of counter
Input) clockwise direction
Note: The Intelli command center will primarily work for Infotainment functionality.
SOS
C: SOS calling For Auto mode - Auto Mode will be active when Switch 'B' is
D: Roof Lamp ON in pressed position. In Auto Mode, the roof lamps will turn
ON automatically when any of the doors are opened. The
A B C D E E: RHS reading lamp roof lamps will also turn OFF automatically after preset time
once the doors are closed.
For Reading Lamp – Reading Lamp switches 'A' & 'E' can be
independently pressed for LH and RH lamps. Press the
switch again for switching OFF
Your vehicle head lamps are vented and moisture may be collected
on the inside of the head lamp lens under certain climatic and
geographical conditions. This moisture will evaporate once the
head lamps have been switched ON for a few minutes.
Head Lamp Levelling System Select the suitable switch position depending on the pay
loading condition as advised in the table.
When the vehicle is either fully or partially loaded, it may
have an upward inclination disturbing the head lamp
aiming. A correct head lamp setting provides good visibility
to the driver with minimum inconvenience to other road The headlights can only be adjusted when the low beam is
users. switched ON.
To properly aim the head 8.11.3 Auto Head Lamp Booster (If equipped)
lamp beam, use the head
lamp levelling switch. This
switch is located on the When the switch is in the
right side of the steering Auto mode and high beam.
column shroud in the Then when the vehicle
instrument panel. This speed crosses 80 Kmph the
switch has four positions high beam intensity and
marked as 0, 1, 2 & 3. reach increases. The higher
reach of the beam is helpful
to have vision for the higher
Switch Vehicle Loading Condition speed
Position
0 Driver/Driver with Front Passenger The booster will turn OFF automatically when vehicle speed
Driver + Front passenger + Second row comes below 75 kmph
1 occupied
2 All seats occupied
All seats occupied with luggage OR Driver
3 with luggage at extreme rear side
8.11.4 Daytime Running Lamp (DRL) / Rear Park The following conditions are to be met for the lamps to
Lamp (if equipped) switch ON:
Fog lamps (if equipped) are to be used along with head lamp
low beam, to improve the vision during foggy and misty
If customer doesn’t want the DRL/Rear Park Lamp to be ON, he can disable
through infotainment settings. conditions.
Front Fog Lamps ON
8.11.5 Cornering Lamp (if equipped)
control stalk clockwise aligning the front fog lamp icon to 8.11.7 Puddle Lamp (if equipped)
the “arrow” on the inner fixed stalk as shown.
The front fog lamp indicator in the instrument cluster Puddle lamps are provided
indicates the operation status. at the bottom of the front
doors. They are switched
ON automatically when the
front doors are opened.
Fog lamps will turn ON only if parking lamp is ON due to This illuminates the ground
Park light input or Auto light input. below the respective door
Fog Lamps OFF thereby assisting in a safe
entry and exit.
8.12.1 Auto Hazard Warning Lamp • Driver door open within 3 mins from KEY OUT
• Head lamp would turn ON only if the ambience light is
Hazard lamps are turned on automatically during bonnet found dark by the light sensor
open in vehicle stationary condition.
To extend FMH;
Hazard lamps are turned on automatically for 10 seconds
during panic braking condition to indicate following traffic. • The first RKE/PKE LOCK command will be used for locking
all doors
Hazard lamps are turned on automatically in case of an
unfortunate event of an accident where Airbags are • Successive RKE/PKE LOCK commands will be used for
deployed. In such a scenario, the hazard lamps will be on for toggling the current status of the head lamp low beam
30 minutes or it can be turned off by operating Hazard • Each time FMH is extended the head lamp low beam will
switch (Off to On) or Ignition reset (Ignition Off and On) be kept/turned on for the next 20 seconds
To disable FMH • FMH can be activated by pressing lock button in key fob
twice. First press locks the vehicle & second press
• Park lamp transition from OFF to ON enables head lamp low beam for 20 seconds.
• Ignition off to any other state • Pressing unlock button in key fob disables FMH feature &
• FMH ON 20 seconds expires unlocks the vehicle.
• FMH Max time is 3 minutes expires To extend the FMH feature further for 20 secs., press RKE
LOCK button once. This FMH extension can be availed for
With FMH mode ON, if the UNLOCK signal is received twice maximum 3 minutes from the first activation.
from RKE; the feature gets deactivated and cannot be
extended further. Also, the doors are unlocked and vehicle With FMH mode ON; First LOCK signal received from RKE
is disarmed. will lock the doors and subsequent LOCK signal is used to
toggle the head lamp ON and OFF.
8.14 Follow-Me Home Lamp (FMH) Non RLS (if To deactivate FMH:
equipped) • Switch ON the parking lamps
This feature helps the driver and passengers to easily get • Switch the ignition key to either ACC or ON in position
out of the vehicle during poor light conditions. The head
lamp low beam is turned ON for about 20 seconds assisting • Press the RKE unlock/lock button once
the passengers to find their way. It will only work if prior to • Head lamp switches ON for 20 secs. and switched OFF
switching off the engine, the head lamp were ON for a automatically
predefined time
With FMH mode ON, if UNLOCK signal is received twice from
To activate FMH: RKE; the feature gets deactivated and cannot be extended
• Switch OFF the parking lamps further. Also, the doors are unlocked, and vehicle disarmed.
8.15 Lead Me to Vehicle Lamp(LMV) (if equipped) 8.16 Remote Engine Start (If equipped)
LMV is the feature that will switch ON the head lamp for 20 This feature enables the customer can remotely Start/Stop
secs. helping the passengers to reach the parked vehicle the vehicle engine using mobile application.
safely and comfortably at night.
This feature is mainly used to switch on the car air
LMV is activated: conditioner remotely via Adrenox connect app. When the
engine starts, the vehicle AC automatically turns ON (If DATC
• Pressing the unlock button on the RKE two times equipped). This feature is available in automatic
LMV is de-activated: transmission and manual transmission variants with EPB.
• Switch ON the parking lamps The following conditions must be met for a vehicle to be
started remotely:
• Switch the ignition key to either ACC or ON in position
• All doors including bonnet and tail door must be closed
• Press the RKE lock/unlock button once and locked.
• Head lamp switches ON for 20 secs. and switched OFF • Vehicle Automatic transmission should be in P (Park) OR
automatically Manual transmission (gear in neutral Position) with EPB
To extend the LMV feature further for 20 secs., press RKE applied .
UNLOCK button once. This LMV extension can be availed for • Ignition must be in OFF position.
maximum 3 minutes from the first activation.
• Sufficient Fuel and battery charge for the car to start.
With LMV mode ON; First UNLOCK signal received from RKE
will unlock the doors and subsequent UNLOCK signal is
used to toggle the head lamp ON and OFF.
8.17 Windshield Wipers Auto Mode (if equipped): Auto mode wiping is selected
when the wipe control stalk is pushed down to position C. In
8.17.1 Wiper Control Stalk the AUTO mode, the wiper operates based on rain intensity.
The delay between each wipe can be varied by rotating the
wiper speed intensity rotary switch (F).
A: Flick- Wipe (MIST)
A
B: Off
B ON
INT
C: Intermittent (INT)/AUTO When the ignition key is in the “ON” position, the wiper will
C D: Low Speed (LO) automatically operate once if the wiper switch is turned
F
E: High Speed (HI) from the “OFF” to the “AUTO” position.
D
E F: Rotary Switch Low Speed Wiping: Push the wipe control stalk down to the
position (D) to operate the wiper at a fixed low speed.
Wiper Off: The wipe function is OFF when the wiper control High Speed Wiping: Push the wiper control stalk down to
stalk is in neutral position (B). position (E) to operate the wiper at a fixed high speed.
Flick-Wipe (Mist): Push the wipe control stalk to position (A)
for a flick-wipe, hold to operate the wipe continuously 8.17.2 Wipe/Wash
(simultaneously lift the wiper stalk towards the steering
wheel to operate the wash). The stalk automatically comes Pull/Lift the wiper control stalk towards the steering wheel
back to position (B) when released. from any position to activate wipe/wash function. Washer
fluid from front washer reservoir is pumped and sprayed
Intermittent (INT) (If equipped): Intermittent (INT) mode onto the windshield. The wipers wipe the windshield 3 times
wiping is selected when the wipe control stalk is pushed after the washer spray is stopped. Hold the stalk in position
down to position (C). In the INT mode, the wiper operates on for continuous spray of washer fluid.
preset intervals. The delay between each wipe can be varied
by rotating the wiper speed intensity rotary switch (F).
8.17.4 Rear Wiper-INT Mode Rotate the outer rotary switch on the wiper control stalk to
align the “arrow” on the stalk to the rear wipe “ON” position
to operate the rear wiper continuously .
9.1.3 Rollo Shade Close Skyroof Smart Open by Key Fob Unlock Button
9.1.8 Pinch Protection For The Power Skyroof 9.1.9 Emergency Close Feature
• Pinch protection can help reduce the risk of pinching • The express (One Touch) / Manual (long press) skyroof
injuries when closing the power skyroof.. and Rollo Shade Close function may not work due to -
• If the power skyroof closing meets resistance or there is • Consecutive several attempts to close skyroof and Rollo
something in the way, the power skyroof opens again Shade.
immediately.
• Pinch protection is only for closing skyroof and Rollo
• Check why the power skyroof did not close & avoid such shade.
incident in future for your safety
• Excessive Ice / Dirt accumulation on the skyroof Glass /
• Try to close the power skyroof again guiderails.
Follow the emergency close command as below:
• Emergency close feature can be used, if Sliding skyroof or
• Without pinch protection, the power skyroof will close Rollo shade consecutive reversal movement observed 3
with enough force to cause serious personal injury.
times within 10 sec then continue with step 2 as below to
• Always be careful when closing the power skyroof. use Emergency close feature.
• Pinch protection cannot prevent fingers or other parts of • On the 4th attempt continuously push the skyroof close
the body from being pressed against the edge of the roof; switch - position (3) or Rollo shade close switch - position
may result in injuries (4) until it closes completely to ensure occupant privacy,
safety & theft prevention from skyroof open window.
• If the power skyroof malfunctions, pinch protection may This is Emergency Close Feature. (Never keep your hands
not function properly. Visit an Mahindra Authorised or head in the skyroof window while performing this
Dealer or an authorized Mahindra Service Facility for operation it may cause severe injury, since Anti-pinch
assistance. function will not work at this 4th attempt).
• Once the skyroof or Rollo Shade is completely closed,
release the switch.
• Alternatively, User may wait for min. 30 secs before 9.1.10 Initializing The Power Skyroof
operating skyroof and Rollo Shade, then skyroof can be
operated with Normal Functions. Condition for Initializing the Skyroof /Rollo Shade
• If the skyroof doesn’t operate as above, Visit Mahindra If the vehicle battery has been disconnected during skyroof /
Authorised Dealer for assistance. Rollo shade movement and reconnected or it is dead or any
fuse is replaced, the skyroof / Rollo shade must be
initialized. Otherwise Express (one touch) function (open/
close/tilt) and pinch protection function will be deactivated.
Initializing command procedure:
1. Turn ON the ignition
(Pre condition shall be Close position for both skyroof
and Rollo shade)
2. Close the skyroof fully by pushing ‘skyroof close
switch’ (3) and keep the switch pushed for 1-2 seconds
after the roof is fully closed, till clicking sound comes
from skyroof .
3. Close the Rollo shade fully by pushing ‘ Rollo Shade
close switch’ (4) and keep the switch pushed for 1-2
seconds after the Rollo shade is fully closed, till
clicking sound comes from Rollo shade.
4. The Initializing command is complete, Check if the
Express open/close features are working.
If the initializing procedure is not completely performed,
then it has to be run again from step 2.
Self learning command procedure: • To help prevent damage, remove ice and snow from the
skyroof before opening or tilting it in winter season.
1. Self-learning must be performed when skyroof/ rollo
sunshade assembly is replaced or when false anti- • Always close the skyroof before leaving the vehicle or if it
pinch reversal movement (reversal without any begins to rain. If the skyroof is open or tilted, rain could
obstruction) is noticed enter the vehicle interior and cause extensive damage to
the electrical system. This could result in further vehicle
2. Close the skyroof fully by pushing ‘skyroof close damage.
switch’ and keep the switch pushed continuously. Do
not release the switch and wait for following actions to • Remove leaves and other objects from the skyroof
perform. guiderails regularly either by hand or using a vacuum
cleaner.
3. Sliding skyroof will start opening after 5 sec pause and
close automatically. Release the Switch to complete • If the power skyroof malfunctions, pinch protection may
the procedure. not function properly. See an Mahindra Authorised
Dealer or an authorized Mahindra Service Facility.
4. Close the Rollo fully by pushing ‘Rollo Shade close
switch’ and keep the switch pushed continuously. Do • The Rollo Shade can be opened and closed
not release the switch and wait for following actions to independently when the sliding skyroof is in closed
perform. position.
5. Rollo will start opening after 5 sec pause and close • During sliding skyroof Express (one touch) open/tilt
automatically. Release the Switch to complete the operation, Rollo Shade will also open in synchronization
procedure. with sliding skyroof (Express - Complete Open Feature).
6. The Self learning command is complete.
Incase skyroof and Rollo Shade Close switch is released in the Do not remove vehicle battery while skyroof is in motion
middle of procedure, repeat from step 1.
9.2 Power Window and Skyroof Smart Close and b). Using Adrenox Command
Open
A A
RESUME
START
C Side Vents
ENGINE
STOP
E
2
1
C + AUTO
C
A/C
MAX REAR
MODE
A/C
- A/C
OFF
D Center Vents
D NO OFF
D
USB
F F F Foot Vents
G G
Side Vents: The two side vents are located one each at the Defogger Vents
left and right extreme ends of the instrument panel. Both
the side vents provide air flow to the front seat passengers.
SET+
VOL +
ENTER
SET-
RESUME
START
ENGINE
STOP
3
2
1
REAR
A/C ECON
A/C
NO OFF
USB
Third Row Vents: The third row vents (LH & RH) are located A Temperature control Knob
on side trims on either side of the third row seats.
B Air distribution/Mode switches
It will be provided only for variants which have the third-row C Front defogger switch
seats
D Blower speed control knob
E Rear Defogger switch
F Rear A/C switch
G Recirculation mode switch
H Economy Mode switch
I A/C switch
A B C D
knob, the desired discharged air temperature can be Economy Mode switch (ECON)
obtained.
By rotating the knob anti-clockwise and setting it to the
extreme left position, maximum cooling is obtained. When
the knob is rotated clockwise, the discharged air
progressively starts getting warmer and at the extreme right
position, hot air is discharged.
Blower Speed Control Knob
ECON switch turns ON economy mode. During ECON AC
The blower force-circulates the air through the HVAC unit operation the system automatically cuts OFF at a higher
and distributes it throughout the passenger compartment. temperature than normal AC. The operation can be used
during mild weather conditions for better fuel efficiency.
Comfort level may be compromised during this operation.
Press the ECON switch again to turn OFF economy mode.
A/C switch
This button turns the air-conditioner ON or OFF.
hot weather conditions, it will take a slightly longer time to Re-circulation Mode (Re-circulation mode switch ON)
cool the interior as compared to cooler weather. Fuel
consumption will be relatively higher if the vehicle is being
driven with the air conditioner ON.
Never keep recirculation mode selected continuously for Rear AC blower can be turned ON only when the Rear AC
long period. Prolonged use of the HVAC system in switch is turned ON
recirculation mode may cause windshield/windows to mist/
fog-up, impairing visibility which can lead to an accident,
endangering you and others.
Fresh Air Mode (Re-Circulation Mode Switch Off)
• Face-Foot Mode — When Face-Foot mode switch is • Foot and Front Defogger Mode — When foot and front
pressed, air is discharged from the Center vents, second defogger mode switch is pressed air is discharged from
row vents, Foot vents and side vents. This mode is most the foot vents, side defogger vents and windshield
suitable for directing air flow towards both the face and defogger vents. This mode is most suitable for directing
feet of passengers at the same time air flow towards the feet of passengers while de-misting/
defogging.
A B C D E F G
+ AUTO
DUAL A/C
MAX REAR
Rear defogger switch is located on the ETC control panel. MODE
A/C
-
A/C
OFF
Press the switch once to activate the rear defogger. The LED
on the switch illuminates upon activation and the rear
defogger heats the rear windshield clearing the fog / mist. M L K J I H
Switch OFF the rear defogger by pressing the switch once as W62G109
Below mentioned switches/ The air conditioner does not operate by directly pressing the
knobs in DATC control blower speed control switches if the A/C switch is not
panel is pressed/Rotated, pressed. However, the air flows due to the fan operation.
respective icons and AUTO switch
changes are displayed in
the infotainment screen.
+ AUTO
DUAL A/C
MAX REAR
MODE - OFF
Blower speed control switches A/C A/C
W62G110
+ AUTO
If you press the AUTO switch with AC ON, AUTO indicator
DUAL A/C
appears on Infotainment screen and the set temperature is
MAX REAR
MODE
A/C
-
A/C
OFF
maintained while the airflow and air distribution are
W62G98
automatically controlled.
The indicator lamp lights up while AUTO switch is operating,
You can adjust the airflow by Pressing the Blower speed and the lamp turns off when the AUTO switch is turned OFF.
control switches with ignition ON. If you adjust the airflow
using blower speed control switches in AUTO mode, the Front Defogger switch
AUTO indicator on Infotainment screen goes off and the
operation mode is changed to the manual mode.
+ AUTO
Blower speed can be increased by pressing the blower DUAL A/C
speed '+' switch and blower speed can be decreased by MODE
MAX
-
REAR
OFF
pressing the blower speed '-' switch. A/C A/C
W62G108
Use this switch for quick defogging with the engine ON. Co–Driver temperature control knob
When you press this switch, its indicator lamp turns ON, and
the airflow direction is changed to the windshield and door
glasses while outside air comes in with A/C operation.
+ AUTO
At this time A/C, front defogger and Fresh air indicators DUAL A/C
DUAL A/C
The co-driver set temperature is visible on the infotainment
MAX REAR screen
MODE - OFF
A/C A/C
W62G101
Recirculation mode switch Automatic selection of the fresh or air circulation mode
When the front defogger switch is pressed, outside air
+ AUTO automatically comes in. When the switch is pressed again,
DUAL A/C the previous mode is restored.
MAX REAR
MODE - OFF
A/C A/C
DUAL switch
W62G135
+ AUTO
If you press this switch with AC ON, the indication lamp
DUAL A/C
lights turn up and the air recirculation indicator on
MAX REAR
Infotainment display is displayed. If you press this switch MODE
A/C
-
A/C
OFF
again, the indication lamp turns off and the air source
W62G100
selection is changed to Fresh air intake mode.
This function allows controlling the Co-Driver side
temperature separately with engine ON.
Do not use recirculation mode in the vehicle for extended
• If you press the DUAL mode switch, the indicator lamp
periods of time with every window closed. Doing so can
lights up and DUAL mode indicator on the infotainment
cause headache, drowsiness and fogged window due to lack
displays comes on
of oxygen
If exhaust gas comes in, there is a danger of carbon • When the driver temperature control knob is rotated, the
monoxide poisoning. Set to the fresh air intake mode after driver side temperature on the infotainment display is
passing through a dusty or polluted area with air adjusted as desired and when co-driver temperature
recirculation mode in operation. control knob is rotated, co-driver side temperature on
the infotainment display is adjusted as desired
• While the DUAL mode switch is operating, its indicator
lamp turns ON and the lamp turns off when the DUAL
mode switch is turned OFF.
When the DUAL mode switch is turned off, the passenger When choosing foot mode, some air flows out from
temperature returns to the driver side set temperature. windshield defogger vents , Side defogger vents and side
vents.
Mode switch
Driver temperature control knob
Each time you press this switch with IGN ON, the air
distribution mode is changed and displayed as shown in the To adjust the temperature as desired, rotate the driver side
figure below. temperature control knob
When you press this switch in AUTO mode (AUTO indicator The temperature decreases, when the driver temperature
ON), the system is changed to the manual control mode control knob is rotated in anti-clockwise direction &
(AUTO indicator OFF). temperature increases, when the driver temperature
control knob is rotated in clockwise direction
+ AUTO
DUAL A/C
+ AUTO
MAX REAR
MODE - OFF
A/C A/C DUAL A/C
MAX REAR
W62G104 MODE - OFF
A/C A/C
W62G114
Face-Mode Foot-Mode
Foot/
Face/Foot-
Defogger-
Mode
Mode
+ AUTO + AUTO
W62G111 W62G103
Air conditioner is turned ON and OFF with this switch. MAX AC mode can be used to attain MAX cooling in a short
While air conditioner switch is operating, its indicator period of time.
lamp lights up, and the lamp turns off when the AC is
When MAX AC switch is pressed
OFF.
1. In cabin temperature is set to minimum
Rear A/C switch
2. Blower fan speed is set to Max
Rear AC Switch is used to turn ON/OFF the Rear AC
blower. 3. Air intake mode is set to recirculation mode
4. Air distribution mode is set to Face mode
Rear AC blower can be turned ON only when the Rear AC Rear Defogger Switch
switch is turned ON
+ AUTO
W62G102
Rear defogger switch is located on the DATC control panel. Co–driver Temp Driver Temp Control
Press the switch once to activate the rear defogger. The LED 1 3
Control Knob Knob
on the switch illuminates upon activation and the rear
defogger heats the rear windshield clearing the fog / mist. 2 Auto Indicator ON
Switch OFF the rear defogger by pressing the switch once as
soon as the fog / mist is cleared. Use only when the engine is running.
If the rear defogger switch is not switched OFF manually, it 1. Press the AUTO switch.
will turn OFF automatically after a pre-defined time, based 2. AUTO indicator is displayed on the Infotainment
on ambient temperature. If you want to switch the rear Screen.
defogger ON again, press the rear defogger switch again.
3. Set the desired cabin temperature with the
On second and subsequent activations of the rear defogger temperature control knob.
in the same ignition cycle, the rear defogger ON time will be
half the duration of the first activation. 4. The temperature of the passenger compartment is
automatically maintained according to the set
temperature.
9.3.4 DATC – Auto Operation Mode
5. If the driver and co-driver require different
temperatures in their respective zones, the same can
1 2 3 be done by pressing the dual mode Switch and
subsequently, setting different temperatures using
temperature control.
+ AUTO
DUAL A/C
When you use the blower speed control switches, mode
MAX REAR
switch (air source selection switch) or defogger switch
MODE - OFF
A/C A/C during the auto operation mode, AUTO indicator on the
W62G128 display goes out and the air conditioner system can be
controlled manually.
9.3.5 DATC – Manual Operation Mode Use only when the engine is running.
1. Press AC ON switch
1 2 3 4 5 2. Set the desired temperature by rotating the
temperature control knob
+ AUTO 3. Adjust the blower speed by pressing the blower speed
DUAL A/C
control switches
MAX REAR
MODE
A/C
-
A/C
OFF
4. Select the air flow by pressing the air distribution/
mode switch
W62G130
5. Select the air source mode by pressing recirculation
mode switch
Co–driver Temp Recirculation Mode
1 4
Control Knob Switch In manual mode, the AUTO indicator on display does not
come on and you can manually adjust the climate
Driver Temp Control conditions by controlling the temperature, blower speed,
2 Mode Switch 5
Knob mode (air distribution), A/C, air source selection, and DUAL
temp. selection control switches.
Blower Control Speed
3
Switch
To activate the auto operation mode, press AUTO switch.
• Under Climate control screen select Climate icon • Vehicle cabin will be
cooled down before
• All HVAC setting can be changed by pressing respective entering vehicle. Thus,
symbols or buttons in climate screen making cabin more
comfortable for the
passengers when they
W22G148
enter the car that was
parked in the hot sun
In Manual transmission (with EPB) vehicle 1. Duration time : User can select the time duration for
• All Doors closed which remote cooling will be active using Adrenox
connect mobile App, Duration can be selected from
• EPB is Engaged minimum of 2 mins to maximum of 15 mins.
• Fuel level is greater than 10 liters 2. Cabin Temperature settings: User can change
temperature settings during Remote cooling
• Vehicle should be in Standstill
3. Front defrost: User can Activate /De-activate front 9.3.8 Rear AC Control
defrost during remote cooling by selecting front
defrost option in mobile app Third Row Blower Speed Control
4. Rear Defrost: User can Activate /De-activate Rear Rear blower speed control knob is provided below the third
defrost during remote cooling by selecting Rear row (RH) vent to control the air flow to the third-row vents.
defrost option in Adrenox connect mobile App,
Once vehicle is started remotely customer will get feedback
in the Adrenox connect mobile App,
Remote cooling operation is suggested to be used while 9.3.9 Rapid Cabin Cooling
vehicle is parked in open sunny area for long duration. It is
recommended not to operate Remote cooling when vehicle Rapid Cabin Cooling In DATC
is parked in a closed environment.
For rapid cooling of the cabin, the following AC settings are
recommended:
• Make sure that all the windows are fully closed blower speed and temperature control knob can be re-
adjusted as desired.
• Fully open the vents and adjust Louvres to direct air
toward face
• Turn ON AC If your vehicle was parked in the hot sun with all the
• Press MAX AC Switch windows closed, drive the vehicle with windows open for the
first few minutes. This will help in venting the hot interior air
Rapid Cabin Cooling In ETC out and allow the air conditioner to cool the cabin quickly.
In case you are leaving the vehicle parked in sun frequently
For rapid cooling of the cabin, the following AC settings are then activate the Active Cooling Option.
recommended:
• Make sure that all the windows are fully closed 9.3.10 Rapid Cabin Heating
• Set the blower to maximum speed
For rapid heating of the cabin, the following AC settings are
• Fully open the vents and adjust Louvres to direct air recommended:
toward face
1. Make sure that all the windows are fully closed.
• Set the air distribution control to face mode
2. Set the blower to maximum speed.
• Set air intake control to recirculation mode
3. Set the air distribution control to foot mode.
• Turn the air conditioner ON
4. Set air intake control to recirculation mode.
• Set the temperature control knob to extreme left
(coolest) position 5. Set the temperature control knob to extreme right
(hot) position.
For faster cabin cooling, you can select re-circulated air
intake mode initially. Once passenger compartment reaches 6. For de-humidified heating, switch the air conditioner
a comfortable temperature, shift to fresh air mode. Also ON. So on rainy conditions if the heater is ON then
also keep the AC ON.
For faster cabin heating, you can select re-circulated air • Reduced air flow because of clogged HVAC filter or any
intake mode initially. Once passenger compartment reaches other obstructions in air flow path may lead to
a comfortable temperature, blower speed and temperature inadequate defogging/de-misting performance. If air flow
control knob can be re-adjusted as desired. seems to have considerably reduced, get the filter
cleaned or replaced immediately. Air flow path should be
kept free of obstructions
In extreme cold weather conditions, the engine coolant • Reduced cooling performance from air conditioner may
takes time to get heated up. Hence, it might take a while for lead to inadequate defogging/de-misting. If cooling effect
hot air discharge, even when blower is running and seems to have dropped considerably, get the air
temperature control dial is set to hot position. conditioning system checked by an Mahindra Authorised
Dealer
9.3.11 Points to Remember
• For quickly defogging/de-misting outside of front Your vehicle is equipped with a HVAC filter. If the AC
windshield, it is advisable to operate the windshield performance is considerably low, it is recommended to have
wiper/washer for few times intermittently the HVAC filter checked at the nearest Mahindra Authorised
Dealer.
• If snow has deposited on windshield, use ice scraper to Keep in mind that a choked filter will also lead to poor
remove ice deposited before using wiper cooling.
• In freezing weather, warm the front windshield with the
defogger before using the windshield washer. Also use a
washer fluid having anti-freezing properties. These will Never operate HVAC system with the filter removed. This
help prevent the washer fluid from freezing on your may result in premature failure of system components.
windshield
• Dirty/contaminated windshield would make misting /
fogging-up worse. Always keep the inside and outside of
windshield clean
9.4 Surround View System (If equipped) angle of any of the camera is changed e. g. after a
collision, then do not use the feature for safety reasons
Surround View System assists in parking and low speed as the image stitching may not be correct.
maneuvering by providing views of vehicle’s surroundings
with the help of 4 cameras located in the front grille, in the • If the exterior mirror is folded or out of place then image
tailgate applique and on both exterior mirrors. stitching may not be correct.
When driver activates SVS by switch while driving forward • Use the Surround View System only when all the doors
above 15 km/h vehicle speed , it assists by providing rear and the tailgate are closed.
surroundings view. • The area around the vehicle is shown using the camera
images and the car image is a standard graphic shown by
the system. Hence the car image shown on the screen is
Before using the system, Make sure that the camera lenses are clean and not real and may not represent your actual vehicle.
not covered by any dust or other obstructions that may impair the system.
• Objects and obstacles above the camera height or out of
Disclaimer the field of view of the cameras are not displayed.
• The cameras in Surround View System provide only the • Camera lenses distort the actual view surroundings to
view and do not detect or alarm if any obstacles are in capture more coverage. The objects appear are altered
the view. Driver must check for the surrounding for any and may not be dimensionally same as real as on the
possible collisions with obstacles. screen.
• There is a noticeable blind area of about 20cm where the • The accuracy of the orientation decreases when the
cameras cannot see around the periphery of the vehicle. vehicle is raised/lowered based on the occupant’s weight.
Driver must be careful to check for any obstacles in the
blind areas.
The display screen shows the direction in which the rear of the vehicle is
• Surround View System provides the views by stitching the travelling when showing rear view. The front of the vehicle swings out more
views from the four cameras with respect to their than the rear of the vehicle. Maintain sufficient distance to the obstacles so
geometric orientations. If the position or the installation that the exterior mirrors or the corners of the vehicle does not collide with
any obstacles.
9.4.1 SVS Activation and Deactivation SVS deactivates when one of the following action is
performed
Use any of the following methods to activate SVS
• Press SVS Hard Switch on center fascia switch bank. • Driver presses “Close button” in
Infotainment screen.
• When SVS hard switch is pressed
DRIVE
MODE
again.
ON OFF OFF
• System activates when the engine is running and the shift SVS is a supplementary driving assist function. Always check
lever is in the R (Reverse) position regardless of vehicle the vehicle's surroundings for safety. Do not solely rely on
speed or switch position. what is displayed on the screen. What you see on the screen
may differ from the actual vehicle's location.
When you touch car model in the bird’s eye view area, an
oval will appear with 8 camera icons to switch different
3D views.
Sl. Description
Icons
No
Transparent Bottom View (If equipped) 9.4.3 Static & Dynamic Guidelines
When you touch on SVS car in bird’s eye view, SVS car Disclaimer
changes to semi-transparent and view beneath the ground
(Transparent Bottom View) will be visible once the vehicle Static and dynamic guidelines can be used as references
starts moving as lane marking under vehicle bottom is only and may differ if camera orientation is altered due to
visible in below image. passenger occupancy.
• Dynamic Guidelines
Orange indicate the path • It is driver’s responsibility to identify the suitable parking
the vehicle will traverse area to park car safely.
with the current steering
angle.
You can select from settings Choose
to have parking guidelines Vertical
(Static and Dynamic) in 2D Parking icon
or/and 3D Views. from SVS settings. Below
overlays (Ref Img No:
W62K54) will appear on
9.4.4 Parallel and Vertical (Perpendicular) Parking either side.
Assistance
Disclaimer Step 2: Keeping the Vehicle Ready for parking
Parallel and Perpendicular Parking are only assistance and • Move the vehicle either forward or backward so that the
driver should take care of surrounding for collisions. end point of the shortest arc [either blue or green, based
on the side in which the vehicle will be parked], is
A. Vertical/Perpendicular Parking coinciding with the parking slot line. (Blue arc line as
shown in the image Ref. Img. No. W62K54)
Step 1:Selecting the Perpendicular Parking Mode
• Once it is done, turn the steering wheel in the direction of
Drive ahead of the parking slot so that Camera can have the the parking slot, till the rack end/extreme end move of
parking slot view. steering wheel.
• Steering will be straight if both dynamic and static lines from settings.
are overlapping
To turn off BVM, deactivate turn indicator. SD card is used to store the recorded video.
Video Playback
1: To close a video
• Under DVR interface, click "Emergency Video" folder or 2: To replay previous video
"General Video" folder to replay any video file.
3: To play video fast
• Saved video file name is as per date and time of recorded backward
video. Video files are saved with .AVI file extension. 4: Pause/play
1 2 3 4 5 6
Eg. File Name - 20151203_163028.AVI 5: To play video slow
20151203 - YYYYMMDD (Y-Year, M-Month, D-Day) forward
6: To replay next video
163028 - HHMMSS (H-Hour,M-Minute, S-Second)
• Click the “edit” button to delete/move video files. DVR Settings
Current recording will get paused during video playback. • In DVR mode, click
setting button to enter
the setting interface.
• Video length setting: DVR
video clip recording time
can be selected as 3
Playback and editing
minutes or 5 minutes
interface show as below:
based on settings.
9.4.7 SVS Troubleshooting -When the head lights are not bright due to dirt on the lens
of if the aiming is not adjusted properly.
• When there is any error in system/camera lost
connection, the corresponding camera view on screen -When strong light rays falls on the camera. (For example,
shows green color with an icon indicating camera error. the light directly shines on the front of the vehicle at sunrise
Visit nearest Mahindra Service Center for assistance. of sunset).
• In case of malfunction , system shows a pop-up message -When a sudden change in brightness occurs. (For example,
"Please Contact Service Center" when the vehicle enters or exits a tunnel or under a bridge).
• Video may get blur if camera is exposed to bright light
9.4.8 System Limitations and area around is dark/shadowed.
• SVS Camera images are reproduced slightly delayed and
• Surround View System is subject to certain system not in real time due to processing and stitching.
limitation and may be unavailable or only partially
available in the following situations: • Sometimes during SVS activation , you may not see stable
video feed as some parameters update happens.
-During bad weather (rain, fog, snow, etc.)
• When SVS is used in the area with AC light sources , black
-At night or in very dark places. bands might be seen running in the video feed.
-Display may get flicker, if the area around cameras area is • If video file is corrupted , you may observe black screen
lit by LED or fluorescent lighting. while replaying the video and system will reset to default
view.
-If there is a sudden change in temperature, from cold to
hot areas. • During video playback, you may observe green screen
sometimes.
-If your vehicle got damaged and if any camera position and
the settings got changed.
-When rain, snow, dirt or an object adheres in front of the
camera lens..
System Maintenance
• DVR may not record properly if the power is interrupted • Always keep all camera lens clean. Foreign materials on
in between of usage. e. g during crash, low battery, the camera lens can cause system error and reduced
removal of battery and other reasons. visibility.
• Use SD card as fresh and formatted before first use and • Always use clean water & soft nonabrasive cloth to clean
do not swap SD cards frequently. the lens
• SVS is only a supplementary function and may display • Don’t clean the camera lens and the area around the
obstacles from a distorted perspective. cameras with a power washer.
• Avoid using SVS if you are having eye color blindness or • When SVS parts need to be replaced due to damage/
impaired color vision. non-functioning / any other reason or abnormal video
with "No Panoramic Calibration" text , Visit nearest
• Objects above the ground or hanged may appear to be Mahindra Service Center for recalibration.
far away than they are. But in reality, objects shall be
closer to your car. In such cases, avoid using guidelines • Always clean camera lens smoothly and don’t apply much
to judge the distance. Since it leads to mis-adjustments pressure.
and increase the risk of collision with your car.
• SVS video is shown based on driver activation but it
cannot be used to see a complete surrounding view
which cannot replace the driver for looking into exterior
and interior view mirrors.
• Some obstacles are hard to depict and thus very difficult
recognize due to stitched images, hence sole-reliance on
the system may result in a collision.
10.1 Hazard Warning Flashers Tow hook is a screw on type, and it is available in the tool kit
organizer behind the rear seats on the floor.
The hazard warning flasher
button is in the central Front Tow Hook Rear Tow Hook
bezel switch bank. Press the
DRIVE
button to turn ON the
hazard warning flashers, all
ON MODE
OFF OFF
Towing Wheels
Towing All Wheel
Option 2WD OFF the
Condition Drive Models
Ground
Flat Bed
Towing � On Trailer ALL �
Flat Towing ✗ Flat Tow NONE ✗
Sling Type
Towing
(Front Wheel � Front ✗
Lift)
Dolly Tow
Sling Type
Towing
Sling Type Towing
(Rear Wheel ✗ REAR ✗
Lift)
In case of emergencies, driver/customer can follow the below steps to connect with our Emergency assistance service either
from the car or through mobile phone.
2. Mahindra With You Hamesha team will call you Ask Mahindra from Infotainment ^ (if equipped)
back for support and guidance By touching the Ask mahindra icon, a call will be triggerd
auto-matically from your XUV700 to Mahindra Support Center
for:
1. Explanation on features and functions.
2. Guidance or assistance for usage of in-car features.
* [108] number is the default option. This number can be changed based on 3. Assisting customers with guiding them to nearest
your preference/location . Contact a Mahindra Authorised Dealer workshop.
^ This feature is available only in cars fitted with telematics unit CAUTION:
# On cars without telematics unit, this function will work if a mobile phone is Some Infotainment features may not work when the Ask Mahindra call is in progress
paired through Bluetooth and connected to the car at the time of the incident.
10.4 Vehicle Does Not Start - Checks If the engine stalls while driving
Before making these checks, make sure you have followed • Reduce your speed gradually, keeping a straight line.
the correct starting procedure and that you have sufficient Move cautiously off the road to a safe place.
fuel. • Turn ON your hazard warning flashers and check for any
If the engine is not cranking or is cranking too slowly / malfunction lamps in the instrument cluster.
intermittently • Turn the ignition OFF, wait for approximately 90 seconds
1. Check that the battery terminals are tight and clean. and try starting the engine again.
2. If the battery terminals are firmly fastened, switch ON • . If the vehicle still does not start, contact an Mahindra
the interior lamps. Authorised Dealer.
10.5 Engine Overheating be too hot. Verify that the engine coolant level in the coolant
recovery tank is maintained between the 'Min' and 'Max'
If the temperature gauge moves beyond the normal mark. Check for possible fluid leakages. Check for damages
operating range toward “H” mark. it indicates the engine to heat exchangers and connecting hoses. Also verify that
overheating that may damage the engine. the radiator shrouds, cooling fan blades and the engine belt
all are in good condition.
When the engine overheats, the Engine Management
System reduces engine power substantially and may even If any evidence of failure is observed, contact the nearest
shut the engine OFF; it is dangerous to continue driving Mahindra Authorised Dealer for help. In case, no system
when the engine has overheated. You need to first cool the leakage/ failure is suspected, driving can be continued.
engine down before starting to drive again.
Either due to severe operating conditions or due to any
Follow the below instructions to cool the engine down: system leakages or failures, the engine can get overheated.
However, if the engine is getting overheated repeatedly,
• Progressively reduce the vehicle speed and bring the even in normal operating conditions, get the vehicle
vehicle to a stop at the side of the road checked by an Mahindra Authorised Dealer as soon as
• Turn ON the hazard warning flashers possible.
Stay clear of hot and rotating vehicle parts while visually both cables and terminals. Use a stiff wire brush to
inspecting the vehicle. The coolant inside the cooling system remove all corrosion. Reconnect the cables to the
is under high pressure and temperature. Never open the battery terminals before jump starting the vehicle.
pressure cap of the degassing tank when the engine is hot.
Not taking precautions may lead to serious injury to your 4. The positive terminal will be marked with a plus sign
skin/eyes. (+) and will usually have a RED cable attached on it.
5. The negative terminal will be marked with a minus
sign (-) and will usually have a BLACK cable attached to
For optimum performance of the cooling system, you must it.
maintain the required coolant level and use only 6. A standalone booster battery can be used to start the
recommended engine coolant. engine when the vehicle battery is low.
7. Take jumper cables and unwind the red and black
10.6 Jump Starting cables.
Jump start can be performed when the battery charge is low 8. Wear safety gear and connect one end of red clamp of
which can be confirmed by performing the following the jumper cable to the positive (+) terminal of the
operations: discharged battery and other end to the positive (+)
terminal of the booster battery.
1. Turn headlamp ON and check whether lights are dim
9. Similarly, connect one end of black clamp of the
2. Try to start the vehicle and check whether engine jumper cable to the negative (-) terminal of the
cranks slowly or not crank at all. booster battery and other end to the negative (-)
3. Open the bonnet and locate the battery. terminal of the discharged battery.
10. Once the jump starting assembly is done, crank the
engine for starting.
It may be necessary to remove the disabled vehicle’s
battery cables from the battery terminals and clean
W12M04
cable from the positive (+) terminal of the booster
battery and the other end of the red clamp from the
positive (+) terminal of the discharged battery.
Make sure none of the cables are dangling into the engine
14. Close the bonnet compartment, where they could be exposed to moving parts.
15. Keep the vehicle's engine running and slightly • Remove the jumper cables once the vehicle starts. Do
accelerate the vehicle to charge the battery. this in the reverse of the order in which they were
attached, and don't let any of the cables or clamps touch
each other (or dangle into the engine compartment)
If the problem persists on next starting cycle, please visit • Disconnect the black clamp of the jumper cable from the
Mahindra Authorised Dealer negative (-) terminal of the discharged battery
• Disconnect the other end of the black clamp from the
negative (-) terminal of the booster battery
• Disconnect the red clamp of the jumper cable from the
positive (+) terminal of the booster battery
• Disconnect the other end of the red clamp from the
positive (+) terminal of the discharged battery
Replace any positive (+) red post protective covers if applicable 10.7 Limp Home Mode
(You have had to remove or open these in the beginning) These
covers help prevent accidental short circuiting of the battery Limp Home Mode is an emergency declared by
the EMS (Engine Management System) due to
• Keep the vehicle's engine running. Run the vehicle above failure or malfunction of one/more critical
idle (slightly revved up with your foot on the accelerator).
sensors/actuators. In this mode, the EMS (Engine
This should give the battery enough charge to start the
Management System) will revert back to basic minimum
vehicle again. If it does not start, either your battery
requirement (fuel quantity / injection timings) to aid the
might be dead or faulty alternator.
driver to bring the vehicle back to the nearest workshop.
The drivability & fuel consumption will be greatly affected.
Improper jump starting procedures can result in battery explosion If vehicle acceleration worsens or if there is a drop in vehicle
and acid burn hazard. performance, there might be a malfunction in the engine
Loosely connected battery cables could damage the electronic management system which triggers/activates the Limp
control units. Home Mode. This condition is accompanied by the check
engine lamp illuminating in the instrument cluster. In this
To disconnect battery terminals, wait for at least 2 minutes to
allow discharge of high voltage or it could lead to personal injury. mode, the vehicle speed is limited, and the accelerator
pedal may not function normally. It is recommended you
While disconnecting, always disconnect the -VE terminal first and contact an Mahindra Authorised Dealer immediately for
while connecting, always connect the -VE terminal last.
assistance.
Do not connect battery terminals with opposite polarity, it will lead
to alternator, Electronic control unit failures. If the above telltale is ON/blinking, It indicates an emergency
Towing a vehicle to start could be dangerous. The vehicle being situation declared by the EMS (Engine Management System)
towed could surge forward when the engine starts, causing the two due to failure of one/more critical sensors/actuators and
vehicles to collide, injuring the occupants. triggers/activates the Limp Home Mode.
Modern vehicles with electronic management systems should not
be jump started without ‘protected’ jump starter leads.
12V
G.CARTIER
005321-OMR
80
30
+
5
20 240 077
fuse.
10
40A
85
87
T
10
5
20
12V
G.CARTIER
60
60
40
80
40
30
+
10 10
20 240 077
15
60
60
40A
15
85
87
T
60
60
40
40
10
10
40
40
12V
G.CARTIER
10 20
80
30
+
20 240 077
25
25
60
60
70A
G.CARTIER
>PARB-GF30<
86
87
5
85
87
40A
T
40
40
30
30
10
12V
30
15
10
03
fuse box .
F40 10 EMS LOADS - LAMBDA / (PETROL)
R26 F8 R18 F13 10
F25 R16 BRAKE LAMP (SWITCH)
R2 F39 F16 F7
F14 30 FRONT BLOWER
F24 F15 - SPARE
F38 F23 F15 F6 F16 25 ABS VALVE (ABS ESP)
Remove the fuse box cover by pressing the clips from both
FUEL PUMP F41 60
R13 ULTRA MICRO RELAY(20A) MAIN BATT - 2
HORN RELAY F42 60 MAIN BATT - 4
R14 MINI RELAY(40A) F43
EMS MAIN 60 MAIN BATT - 1
R15 MINI RELAY(40A) COOLING FAN LOW SPEED F44 5 ABS IGN
R16 MINI RELAY(40A) F45 5 TCU IGN (AT ONLY)
FRONT BLOWER F46 5
R22 ISO MICRO RELAY(35A) STARTER
EMS IGN
R23 ULTRA MICRO RELAY(20A) WATER PUMP (DIESEL)
AC COMPRESSOR F47 10 TURBO REC VALVE / IC FAN RELAY
R25 ULTRA MICRO RELAY(20A) SCR (DIESEL ONLY) (PETROL)
R1, R4, R5, R7, R9, R10, R12, F48 10 (DIESEL) NOx (DIESEL)
R17, R18, R19, R20, 5 (PETROL) EMS RELAY LOADS (PETROL)
SPARES F49 125
R21, R24, R26 & R27 EPS
F50 60 RADIATOR FAN (HIGH SPEED)
F51 150 ALTERNATOR
Ensure the correct rating fuse is replaced with the blown “EF” Fuses (Mini Fuses)
fuse.
Fuse Fuse
Circuit Rating
No.
R5 R6 R7 R8 R9 R10 R11 R12 R13 EMS Batt 1 (Diesel) 15A
F1
EMS Batt 1 (Petrol) 30A
F48 F36
R22 EMS Batt 2 (Diesel) 10A
F47
F35 R23 F2
R4 F34
R20 R14 VVTIN/EX, VOP, Canister (Petrol) 10A
F46
F33 R21 HFM/FMU/FEED Pump Relay (Diesel) 10A
F45 F3
F32 R24 Ignition Coils (Petrol) 15A
F44 F31 F20 F13 F4 BMS* 5A
F43 F30
F12 R19 R15
Spare —
R3
F29 F19 F5
F42 R25 F11
F28 F6 EMS ECU Permanent Batt 5A
F18 F10 Spare —
F41 F27 F7
F17 F9
F40
F26 F8 Horn 20A
R26 F8 R18 R16
F25
F16 F9 Head Lamp Batt +ve 1/ DRL RH 10A
R2 F39 F7
F24
F10 Head Lamp Batt +ve 2/ DRL LH 10A
F38 F23 F15 F6
R27
F5 F11 TCU Batt (AT only) 15A
F22 F3
F37
F21 F14 F4 F2
R17 EMS Loads – Relay /WIF/EGR BP 15A
R1
F51 F50 F49 F12 (Diesel)
F1
ALT+ RAD EPS BAT+ EMS Loads – Lambda/(Petrol) 10A
USE SPECIFIED
FUSES & RELAYS F13 Brake Lamp (Switch) 10A
Relays
R5 R6 R7 R8 R9 R10 R11 R12 R13 Relay Relay Type Application Detail
No.
F36
F48 R2 ISO Power Relay (70A) Cooling Fan High
F35 R22
F47 R23 Speed
R20 R14
R4 F34
F46 R3 ISO Power Relay (70A) Glow Plug (Diesel
F33 R21
F45 Only)
F32 R24
F44 F31 F13
R6 Ultra Micro Relay (20A) Intercooler Fan (Petrol
F20
F30
Only)
F43 F12 R19 R15
R3 F29 F19 R8 Ultra Micro Relay (20A) Shifter Solenoid (AT
F42 R25 F11
F28 Only)
F18 F10
F41 F27 R11 Ultra Micro Relay (20A) Fuel pump
F9
F17
F40
F26 R13 Ultra Micro Relay (20A) Horn relay
R26 F8 R18 R16
F25
R2 F39 F16 F7 R14 Mini Relay (40A) EMS main
F24
F23 F15
F6 R15 Mini Relay (40A) Cooling fan low speed
F38
R27 F5
F22 F3 R16 Mini Relay (40A) Front blower
F37 F14
F21 F4 R17
R1
F2 R22 ISO Micro Relay (35A) Starter
F51 F50 F49
F1 R23 Ultra Micro Relay (20A) AC compressor
ALT+ RAD EPS BAT+
USE SPECIFIED R25 Ultra Micro Relay (20A) SCR (diesel only)
FUSES & RELAYS
R1,R4, R5, R7, R9, R10, R12, R17,
R18, R19, R20, R21, R24, R26 & Spares
R27
25
30
30
30
5
5
15
5 25
52
25
25
01
5
10 30
5
5
15
30
30
15
7.5
01 5
5
5 5
5
5
7.5
10
5
10
5
5
5
10
30
15
5
Fuses
Fuse Fuse
Circuit Rating
No.
F1 Spare 20A
F2 Rear Power Window 30A
F3 Power Window LH 30A
F4 Spare 15A
F5 Accessory Power 25A
F6 Power Window RH 30A
F7 ORVM Switch, WLC 5A
F8 Spare 5A
F9 360 Camera Batt 5A
F10 ITM Batt 15A
F11 Roof Lamp Batt 5A
F12 Spare 10A
F13 Spare 10A
F14 Infotainment Batt 15A
F15 MBFM Batt 5 15A
F16 MBFM Batt 1 25A
F17 MBFM Batt 2 30A
F18 Flush Handle Batt 1 10A
F19 PKE Batt1 / Immo Batt 10A
F20 ICC Batt 5A
F21 IGN - HVAC, Amplifier, Infotainment 5A
IGN - MBFM, Gateway, Cluster, 5A
F22 Display
Fuses
Fuse Fuse
Circuit Rating
No.
F23 MBFM Batt 4 20A
F24 Skyroof Batt 20A
F25 Gateway Batt 5A
F26 Batt - Cluster Display 7.5A
F27 Pke Batt 2/ Ignition Switch Batt 10A
F28 Batt Power Seat Switch, OBD, HVAC 5A
F29 RLS Batt 5A
F30 Rear Blower Batt 10A
F31 Batt - Key Lock Solenoid AT and ITS 5A
F32 Spare 20A
F33 Flush Handle Batt 2 10A
F34 ESCL Batt 7.5A
F35 Eng Comp IGN 5A
F36 IGN - Airbag 5A
F37 IGN - APAS, 360/RVC, Flush Handle 5A
IGN - WLC, Radar, Windshield 5A
F38
Camera
F39 IGN - EPS 5A
IGN - CB Switch, Reverse Lamp MT, 7.5A
F40
DS Switch
F41 IGN - PKE/IMMO 5A
F42 IGN - ITM, EPB Switch, Power Seat 5A
F43 IGN - Reverse Lamp AT 10A
Fuses
Fuse Fuse
Circuit Rating
No.
F44 ACC - Amp, HVAC, Infotainment 5A
F45 SPARE 25A
F46 ACC - Power Seat Vent 10A
F47 ACC - Rear Power Socket 15A
F48 Front Power USB 5A
F49 ACC - PKE, ICC 5A
F50 Start 5A
F51 MBFM Batt3 25A
F52 Spare 30A
F53 Power Seat Batt 15A
F54 Amplifier Batt 30A
* - if equipped
10.9.2 Tool Kit Jack is located on the tool kit organizer behind the rear seats
on the floor. To remove the jack out, follow the process
The tool kit is placed in the tool kit organizer behind the rear below:
seats on the floor. It consist of jack, Screwdriver (+and-), Jack
operating lever, Tow bar, DEO Spanner (10mm x 12mm) and
Wheel spanner
A B C D
To get maximum leverage, fit the spanner to the bolt so that the
Refer to “Temporary Spare Wheel” section in the Starting and Driving handle is on the left side. Grab the spanner near the end of the
chapter for more details. handle and push down on the handle. Be careful that the spanner
The spare wheel provided on your vehicle is smaller in size (T155/90 R18 does not slip off the bolt. Do not remove the bolts but loosen them
113M) and for temporary purpose only. Do not use the spare wheel for by one or two turns.
continuous running.
10.9.4 Wheel Bolt Loosening Do not apply force with your legs (or stand) on the wheel spanner
while tightening or Loosening the wheel bolts.
Before loosening the wheel bolt, Wheel cover/cap must be
removed. To remove the wheel cover, wrap the tip of a screwdriver
with cloth, insert it near the lugs of the wheel cover and pry the
cover away from the wheel.
Block the wheel diagonally opposite the flat tyre to keep the
vehicle from rolling when it is jacked up. When blocking the wheel, To raise the vehicle, insert
place a wheel block in front of one of the front wheels or behind the jack handle into the
one of the rear wheels.
jack. Fit the other end of the
lever into the square slot of
10.9.5 Jacking the wheel spanner and turn
it clockwise to expand the
jack.
Locate the jack points in the Ensure no one is in the vehicle. Raise it high enough so that the
front or rear as needed. spare tyre can be installed. Remember, you will need more ground
They can be identified by a clearance when putting on the spare tyre than when removing the
slot used to fit the jack flat tyre.
precisely.
damage the underbody of vehicle or may allow the vehicle cause wheel bolts to loosen and eventually cause a wheel to come
to fall off the jack and cause personal injury. off while driving.
• Use the jack only for lifting your vehicle during wheel
changing
• When raising the vehicle, do not place any objects on top Reinstall the wheel bolts with
of or underneath the jack the tapered end inward and
tighten by hand. Press the
• Do not raise the jack with someone in the vehicle wheel inward and tighten the
wheel bolts further.
• Raise the vehicle only high enough to remove and change
the wheel
• Follow jacking instructions
• Do not start or run the engine while your vehicle is Never use oil or grease on the bolts. Doing so the spanner slips,
supported by the jack damaging the bolts and may cause personal injuries. Also, bolts
may loosen, and the wheels may fall off, which could cause a
serious accident. If there is oil or grease on any bolt, clean before
installing wheel bolts.
Never get under the vehicle when the vehicle is supported by the
jack alone. Lower the vehicle completely and tighten the wheel bolts using the
Remove the wheel bolts. Lift the flat tyre straight off and place it wheel spanner. Turn the jack-operating lever anti-clockwise using
aside. Roll the spare wheel into position and align the holes in the the wheel spanner to lower the vehicle, making sure the handle
wheel with the hub. Lift up the wheel and get at least the top bolt remains firmly fitted onto the jack handle extension. Do not use
inserted through its hole. Wiggle the wheel and press it back for other tools or any additional leverage other than your hands, such
fitting balance bolts. as a hammer, pipe or your foot. Make sure the spanner is securely
engaged over the bolt.
Before putting on the wheels, remove any corrosion on the
mounting surfaces with a wire brush or such. Installation of wheels
without good metal to metal contact at the mounting surface can
11 MAINTENANCE
11.1 Dimensions
1755
2750
4695
1630
Technical Specifications
ENGINE Diesel (MT/AT/AWD) Petrol (MT/AT)
Displacement/Cubic Capacity 2184 cc 1997 cc
Type 4 Stroke, Turbocharged, DI engine 4 Stroke, Gasoline Direct Injection
Compression Ratio 16 ± 0.5: 1 9.5 ± 0.5: 1
114 kW @ 3750 rpm or
Max. Engine Output 149.2 kW @ 5000 ± 50 rpm
136 kW @ 3500 rpm
360 Nm @ 1500 to 2800 rpm or
Max. Torque 420 Nm @ 1600 to 2800 rpm or 380 Nm @ 1750 to 3000 rpm
450 Nm @ 1750 to 2800 rpm
TRANSMISSION
Type 6 Speed Manual/Automatic
No. of Gears 6 Forward, 1 Reverse
STEERING
Type/Description Column mounted Electric Power Steering
SUSPENSION
Front: Coil Spring with side load compensation on McPherson Strut with Double acting
Hydraulic Shock Absorber
Type/Description Rear: Multi Link Control Blade Suspension with Double acting Hydraulic Shock Absorber &
Linear Coil Spring
Technical Specifications
BRAKES
Service Brake Hydraulic & Vacuum assisted Booster with ABS (Standard) & with ESP (Optional)
Front/Rear Disc
Parking Brake Mechanical Hand Operated (Conventional Type) (or)Electric Parking brake
WHEELS & TYRES
Rim Regular (Alloy & Steel) –7J X 17”, Optional – 7J X 18”, Spare wheel –4.5J x 18
Tyres Regular – P235/65 R17, Optional – P235/60 R18, Spare Wheel –T155 /90 R18
Type Radial Tubeless
Front / Rear - 32 (Up to 5 Persons), Front / Rear - 35 (6 Persons to Fully Laden)
Laden Tyre Pressure (Psi)
Spare Wheel Tyre – 60
FUEL
Fuel Tank Capacity 60 liters
DEF Tank Capacity 20 liters (only for Diesel)
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
System Voltage 12V
Battery Rating 70 Ah
11.4 General Owner's Information Get the most from your vehicle with routine maintenance:
Routine maintenance is the best way to help ensure you get
Your vehicle has been designed for fewer maintenance the performance, dependability, long life and better resale
requirements with longer service intervals to save both your value you expect from your vehicle. This is exactly why we've
time and money. However, each regular maintenance, as put together this Maintenance Section. It outlines the
well as day-to-day care is more important to ensure a services required to properly maintain your vehicle and
smooth, trouble-free, safe and economical operation. It is when they should be performed. The focus is on
the owner's responsibility to make sure the specified maintaining your vehicle while it's running great, which goes
maintenance, including general maintenance service is a long way toward preventing major repairs and expenses
performed. Note that both the new vehicle limited warranty later.
and emission control system limited warranties specify that
proper maintenance and care must be performed. See Here are a few suggestions to help you get started on
Warranty and Service Information Guide for complete routine maintenance:
warranty information. • Familiarize yourself with your vehicle by going through
Where to go for service? your Owner's Manual
Mahindra technicians are well trained specialists and are • Take a few minutes to review this Maintenance Section
kept up to date with the latest service information through • Make it a habit to use this manual to record scheduled
technical bulletins, service tips and in dealership training maintenance in the warranty and Service Information
programmes. They learn to work on Mahindra vehicles Guide
before they work on your vehicle, rather than while they are
working on it. • Consult with your Mahindra Authorised Dealer for all
your vehicle's needs
You can be confident that your Mahindra Authorised Dealer
service department does the best job to meet the Suggestions for Obtaining Service for your Vehicle
maintenance requirements on your vehicle reliably and Prepare for the Appointment: If you have warranty work
economically. to be done, be sure to have the right papers with you. All
work to be performed may not be covered by the warranty.
Discuss additional charges with the service manager. Keep a the terms and provisions of Mahindra warranties applicable
maintenance log of your vehicle's service history. to this vehicle. Mahindra genuine parts, fluids, lubricants
and accessories are available at any Mahindra Authorised
Prepare a List: Make a written list of your vehicle's Dealer. They will help keep the vehicle operating at its best.
problems or the specific work you want done. If you've had
an accident or work done that is not on your maintenance Protect your Warranty: Routine maintenance is not only
log, let the Service adviser/Relationship manager know the best way to help keep your vehicle performing as
about it. intended, it's also the best way to protect your warranty.
Failure to perform scheduled maintenance specified in the
Be Reasonable with Requests: If your list has several items warranty and Service Information Guide will invalidate
and you must have your vehicle by the end of the day, warranty coverage on parts affected by the lack of
discuss the situation with the Service adviser/Relationship maintenance. We can't stress enough how important it is to
manager and list the items in order of priority. keep records of all maintenance. Damage or failures due to
neglect or lack of proper maintenance are not covered
Need Assistance? : It is recommended talking to an
under warranty.
Mahindra Authorised Dealer service manager first. Most
matters can be resolved with this process. If for some Keeping maintenance records is easy with the ‘Warranty and
reason you are still not satisfied, talk to the general Service Information Guide’
manager or owner of the dealership.
It's important to document the maintenance of your vehicle.
If an Mahindra Authorised Dealer is unable to resolve the For your convenience to maintain records of service, the
concern, you may contact any Mahindra Customer Care scheduled maintenance coupons are provided in the service
Executive. They would need the following information: coupon booklet. Every time you bring your vehicle in for
scheduled maintenance, be sure to present this booklet and
Owner's name and address, owner's telephone number
certify the work. Also record the date of service and mileage
(home and office), Mahindra Authorised Dealer name,
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN), vehicle delivery date at the time of service. This will make record keeping easy
and, should your vehicle ever require warranty coverage,
and mileage.
you will have all the documentation to show you've properly
Warranty Information: Read the Warranty Information maintained it.
given in the ‘Warranty and Service Information Guide’ for
Oils, Fluids and Flushing: In many cases, fluid discoloration is a determine the most appropriate mileage to perform the various
normal operating characteristic by itself, and does not necessarily maintenance services. This protects your vehicle at the lowest
indicate a concern or that the fluid needs to be changed. However, overall cost to you. Mahindra recommends that you do not deviate
discolored fluids that also show signs of overheating and/or from the maintenance schedules presented in this Maintenance
foreign material contamination should be inspected immediately Schedule.
by a qualified expert such as the factory trained technicians at your
Mahindra Authorised Dealer. Your vehicle's oils and fluids should Vehicle Self Maintenance - General Precautions
be changed at the specified intervals or in conjunction with a
repair. • Refer to relevant sections of the manual before starting
Chemicals and Additives: Non-Mahindra approved chemicals • Set the parking brake
or additives are not required for factory recommended
maintenance. In fact, Mahindra recommends against the use of
• Block the wheels to prevent the vehicle from moving
such additive products unless specifically recommended by unexpectedly
Mahindra for a particular application. • Turn OFF the engine and remove the key
Your vehicle is very sophisticated and built with multiple complex • Stay clear of hot vehicle parts
performance systems. Every manufacturer develops these systems
using different specifications and performance features. That's • Avoid repeated contact with fluids
why it's important to rely on your Mahindra Authorised Dealer to
properly diagnose and repair your vehicle. • Do not let fuel, coolant and other fluids spill over
electrical and hot vehicle parts
When planning your maintenance services, consider your
Mahindra Authorised Dealer for all your vehicle's needs. • Keep all open flames and other burning material like
cigarettes away from the battery and all fuel-related parts
Get the most from your Service and Maintenance visits:
Getting your vehicle serviced at an Mahindra Authorised Dealer
adds great value to your vehicle in number of ways. Hence, it is
recommended to service your vehicle at an Mahindra Authorised Do not start/run the engine when any engine/peripheral
Dealer only. parts are removed.
Maintenance Interval: Mahindra establishes recommended
maintenance intervals based upon engineering testing to
Petrol Layout
A B C D E F G
USE ONLY
MAHINDRA MAXIMILE
PREMIUM OIL
W62K32
A Windshield Washer Fluid Reservoir D Engine Oil filling Cap G Engine Compartment Fuse Box
B Degassing Tank E Engine Oil Dipstick
C Brake Fluid Reservoir F Battery
Diesel Layout
A B C D E F G
USE ONLY
MAHINDRA MAXIMILE
PREMIUM OIL
A Windshield Washer Fluid Reservoir D Engine Oil filling Cap G Engine Compartment Fuse Box
B Degassing Tank E Engine Oil Dipstick
C Brake Fluid Reservoir F Battery
11.6 General Maintenance • Hoses, joints and pipes for any abnormalities
Inside the Vehicle
• Lights
Exercise extreme caution when the hood is open and engine
is ON. • Warning lamps
Listed below are the general maintenance items that should • Windshield wiper and wash
be performed frequently. In addition to checking the items
listed below, if you notice any unusual noise, fluid leakages, • Steering wheel
smell or vibration, you should investigate the cause or take • Seats/Seat belts
your vehicle to your Mahindra Authorised Dealer or a
qualified service shop immediately. • Accelerator pedal/Brake pedal
• Brakes
Make these checks only with adequate ventilation if you • Parking brake
intend to run the engine. • Gear lever shift mechanism
In the Engine Compartment Outside the Vehicle
• Front windshield washer fluid level • Lamps
• Engine coolant level • Fluid leaks
• Battery condition • Doors and engine bonnet latches
• Brake/Clutch fluid level • Tyre inflation pressure
• Engine oil level • Tyre surface/thread and wheel Bolts
• Fluid leaks
Fluid Leaks: Check the engine compartment and the • Make sure the vehicle is on ground level
underbody of the vehicle for any leaks. If you smell fuel vapor
or notice any leak, have the cause found and corrected • Turn the engine OFF and wait a few minutes for
immediately. the oil to settle down into the oil sump
Engine Oil: Engine oil has the primary functions of lubricating • Apply the parking brake
and cooling the inside of the engine. It plays a major role in
maintaining the engine in proper working order. Therefore, it is
• Open the bonnet, use stay rod to support the bonnet.
Protect yourself from engine heat
essential to check the engine oil regularly.
• Locate and carefully remove the engine oil level dipstick
Engine Oil Consumption: It is normal for engines to
consume some engine oil during operation. Causes of • Wipe the dipstick with a clean cloth. Insert the dipstick fully,
consumption in a normal engine are as follows: then remove it again
• Oil is used to lubricate pistons, piston rings and cylinders. • If the oil level is between “Min” and “Max” marks, the oil
Thin films of oil, left over when pistons move in cylinders, level is acceptable. DO NOT ADD OIL
are sucked into the combustion chamber due to high
negative pressure generated when the vehicle is
decelerating. This oil gets burnt in the combustion chamber
• Oil is also used to lubricate the stems of intake valves. Some
of this oil is sucked into the combustion chamber together MAX
with the intake air and is burnt there
• Engine oil consumption depends upon the viscosity and MIN
quality of the oil, and upon the conditions in which the
vehicle is driven. Oil consumption will be more due to high W62J10
• To access the engine oil filling remove the engine top 11.7.2 Checking/Topping Engine Coolant Level
cover.
• Park the vehicle on flat-horizontal surface.
• If the oil level is below or near the "Min" mark, add Keep the parking brake fully engaged. Shut-off
enough oil through the oil filler cap to raise the level
the engine
within the “Min” and “Max” marks. Wait for few minutes
after every top-up for the oil to settle down before • Wait till the engine cools down and hence coolant
checking the level temperature comes down to normal room temperature
MIN
on the degassing tank
fully/properly seated
11.7.4 Windshield Washer Fluid Top-up 11.7.5 Fuel Filter Water Drain (Diesel)
The windshield washer is located behind the RH Head lamp 1. Park the vehicle on a ground level
in the engine bay. 2. Apply Parking brake and block the wheels.
In very cold weather conditions, fill the reservoir with 3. Switch off the ignition
washer fluid premixed with anti-freeze.
4. Turn the drain plug (Tool is available in the tool kit)
anti-clockwise 3–4 rounds, but DO NOT remove the
plug
If you operate your vehicle in very low temperatures, use
washer fluid with anti-freeze protection. Failure to use 5. Wait till the water drains (few seconds)
washer fluid with anti-freeze protection in cold weather
could result in impaired windshield vision and increase the 6. Turn the drain plug clockwise to close and tighten the
risk of injury or accident. plug firmly
11.8 Maintenance - Inside the Vehicle 11.9 Maintenance - Outside the Vehicle
Lights: Make sure the Head lights, stop lights, tail lights, The following checks should be carried out from time to
turn signal lights and other lights are all working. Check time, unless otherwise specified.
headlight aim.
Lamps: Check and ensure proper functioning of all exterior
Warning Messages and Lamps: Check all warning lamps lamps.
appearing in the instrument cluster. Refer to the relevant
sections in this manual for further details. Fluid Leaks: Check the engine compartment and the
underbody of the vehicle for any leaks. If you smell fuel
Seats: Check that all seat controls such as seat adjusters, vapor or notice any leak, have the cause found and
seat back recliner, etc. operate smoothly and that all latches corrected immediately.
lock securely in any position. Check that the head restraints
move up and down smoothly and that the locks hold Doors and Engine Hood: Check all doors and latches
securely in any latched position. including the tailgate for proper functioning. Make sure the
engine hood secondary latch secures the hood from
Seat Belts: Check that the seat belt system such as buckles, opening when the primary latch is released.
retractors and anchors operate properly and smoothly.
Make sure the belt webbing is not cut, frayed, worn or Tyre Inflation Pressure: Check the Tyre pressure with a
damaged. pressure gauge every week.
11.10 Battery
Your vehicle is equipped with a Mahindra authorized While removing the battery, always disconnect the negative
genuine battery. For longer, trouble-free operation, keep terminal first. And while installing the battery, ensure the
the top of the battery clean and dry. Also, make certain the negative terminal is connected last.
battery cables are always tightly fastened to the battery It is recommended that the negative battery cable terminal
terminals. be disconnected from the battery if you plan to store your
vehicle for an extended period of time. This will minimise
If you see any corrosion on the battery or terminals, remove the discharge of your battery during storage.
the cables from the terminals and clean with a wire brush.
To prevent corrosion, apply petroleum jelly to the battery Battery fluid is a corrosive acid solution; do not allow
terminals. Tighten loose terminals and hold down clamp battery acid to contact eyes, skin or clothing. Don't lean over
nuts only enough to keep the battery firmly in place. battery when attaching clamps or allow the clamps to touch
Tightening excessively may damage the battery terminals. each other. If acid splashes in the eyes or on the skin, flush
contaminated area immediately with large quantities of
For Best Battery Service water.
• Keep the battery securely mounted A battery generates hydrogen gas which is flammable and
explosive. Keep any flame or spark away from the vent
• Keep the battery top clean and dry holes.
• Keep the terminals and connections clean, tight, and Keep batteries out of reach of children. Battery posts,
coated with petroleum jelly or terminal grease terminals and related accessories contain lead and lead
components. Wash hands after handling batteries.
• Rinse any spilled electrolyte from the battery
If the battery has been disconnected or a new battery has
immediately with a solution of water and baking soda
been installed, the clock (if equipped) and the preset radio
(if equipped) stations must be reset once the battery is
reconnected.
Do not disconnect battery terminals while the engine is The replacement battery must meet the specification of the
running. This will adversely affect all electronic controllers. originally fitted battery.
11.11 Wiper Blades 4. Carefully insert the new blade rubber. Then install the
blade assembly in the reverse order of removal.
Lift the wiper arm from its position. Expose the blade lip for
inspection. Clean the wiper blade lips with water applied
with a soft sponge. If the wiper blade is not wiping the glass To prevent damage to the windshield, don’t let the wiper
satisfactorily or is worn-out, cut, cracked or bulging, get it arm slap down on to it.
replaced at an Mahindra Authorised Dealer.
11.12.3 Exterior Chrome • Always read the instructions before using the products
• Mahindra dealers have the exact touch-up paint to match 11.12.6 Plastic (Non-painted) Exterior Parts
your vehicle's color
• Take your vehicle to an Mahindra Authorised Dealer for Use only approved products to clean plastic parts. These
products are available with your Mahindra Authorised Dealer.
paint touch-up or paint repairs
You can use these cleaners:
• Remove particles such as bird droppings, tree sap, insect
deposits, tar spots, road salt and industrial fallout before 1. For routine cleaning of plastic parts
repairing paint chips 2. For tar or grease spots
3. For plastic head lamp lenses • Do not use fuel, kerosene, or paint thinner to clean any
glass parts
11.12.7 Windows and Wiper Blades If you cannot remove those streaks after cleaning with the
glass cleaner or if the wipers chatter and move in a jerky
The front/rear windshield, side windows and the wiper motion, clean the outer surface of the windshield and the
blades should be cleaned regularly. If the wipers do not wiper blades using a sponge or soft cloth with a neutral
wipe properly, substances on the vehicle's glass or the wiper detergent or mild-abrasive cleaning solution. After cleaning,
blades may be the cause. These may include hot wax rinse the windshield and wiper blades with clean water. The
treatments used by commercial car washes, water repellent windshield is clean if beads do not form when you rinse the
coatings, tree sap, or other organic contamination; these windshield with water.
contaminants may cause squeaking or chatter noise from
the blades and streaking and smearing of the windshield. Do not use sharp objects, such as a razor blade, to remove
decals, as it may cause damage to the glass or rear
To clean these items, follow these tips: windshield heater grid lines (if equipped).
• The windshield, rear windows and side windows may be
cleaned with a non-abrasive cleaner such as Clear Spray 11.12.8 Interior Maintenance
Glass Cleaner, available at your Mahindra Authorised
Dealer For fabric, carpets, cloth seats, safety belts and seats:
• The wiper blades can be cleaned with alcohol or • Remove dust and loose dirt with a vacuum cleaner
Premium Windshield Washer Concentrate, available at
your Mahindra Authorised Dealer. This washer fluid
• Remove light stains and soil with carpet and upholstery
contains a special solution in addition to alcohol which cleaner
helps remove the hot wax deposited on the wiper blade • If grease or tar is present on the material, spot-clean the
and windshield. Be sure to replace wiper blades when area first with a stain remover
they appear worn or do not function properly
• Do not use household cleaning products or glass
• Do not use abrasives, as they may cause scratches cleaners, which can stain and discolor the fabric and
affect the flame- retardant abilities of the seat materials
• Do not use cleaning solvents, bleach or dye on the • Do not touch the screen with oily/dirty/wet moisturized
vehicle's safety belts, as these actions may weaken the fingers as the optical film is very sensitive to stains.
belt webbing. Incase of such an event please clean with soft cloth
immediately.
11.12.9 Display Maintenance & Cleaning • The display visible surface must not come in contact with
sharp objects or regular day to day ornaments like finger
Infotainment/Cluster Display Maintenance: rings, watches, bracelets, bangles, car keys etc…
Infotainment/Cluster display is a precise electrical product • When you find a scratch on the screen, do not wipe it
and the surface is covered with soft optical film/coating. strongly. Otherwise it will worsen.
Therefore user should take necessary precaution and care
for cleaning the display visible surface. • Display surface is not so strong for chemical agent. Glass
cleaner including alkali or acid, sunscreen must not be
Cleaning the display area: used. Alcoholic thinner, petrol, abrading agent must not
be used. This may cause discoloration or strain.
• It is recommended to use soft and micro-fiber lint free
cloth to clean the display visible surface. • Antiseptic solution must not be used for cleaning, since it
is not pure alcohol. This may cause stains and/ or
• Wipe gently. Do not rub, as the optical film is sensitive to discoloration.
scratch formation.
• Be careful for scratch by hard matter like finger nail or
steel wool. Display care: Your XUV700 has an exquisite display
integrated with high-end technology. To keep the display
• Do not try to peel off the optical film or coating on the looking new and pristine, wipe the display with a clean soft
screen, since it is attached strongly. cloth.
• Do not add another commercial optical film on to the CONTINUED USAGE OF DISPLAY WITH DUST OR DIRT CAN
display visible area. CREATE MICRO-SCRATCHES DO NOT WIPE DUST OR DIRT
WITH DRY ROUGH CLOTH OR BY HAND
11.12.10 Instrument Panel/Interior Trim • Apply cleaner to a clean white cotton cloth and press the
cloth onto the soiled area and allow this to set in at room
Use only soft microfiber, dry cloth to clean Instrument temperature for 30 minutes
Panel/Interior Trim.
• Remove the soaked cloth, and if it is not soiled badly, use
Clean the instrument panel/Interior trim areas with neutral this cloth to clean the area with a rubbing motion for 60
PH soap and water using soft microfiber / cotton cloth / seconds
sponge, then with a clean and dry white cotton cloth; you
may also use Dash and Vinyl Cleaner on the instrument • Following this, wipe area dry with a clean white cotton
panel and interior trim areas. cloth
• Apply vinyl cleaner to the wiped area and spread around • To help maintain its resiliency and color, use the leather
evenly care kit, available from an Mahindra Authorised Dealer
• Do not use household cleaning products, alcohol
solutions, solvents or cleaners intended for rubber, vinyl
and plastics, or oil/petroleum-based leather conditioners.
of sand in the trunk will give added traction in rear-wheel • Start up the air conditioner and/or heater and run both
drive vehicles and can be used to sprinkle on the snow and for about 10 minute. Again, circulating fluids is essential
ice to gain better traction. And don't forget personal for good life of the system
protection such as a warm coat, hat, gloves and a blanket, in
case you get stuck in a storm. Exterior: Wash and wax your car to provide an extra layer
of protection to your paint.
Keep Enough Fuel in the Tank: Never let the fuel level in
Vinyl and Rubber: Use a good conditioner on all vinyl and
the tank drop below the half-full mark. A sudden storm with
rubber parts to prevent from drying out.
unexpected heavy rains could leave you stranded for hours.
Having adequate fuel supply will allow you to idle the engine Interior: Clean the glass, shampoo the carpets, dig in
from time to time to keep warm. between the seats to see what's there, clean the upholstery
Do not: Tap the ice on the window to crack it or chip it for a in all nooks and corners.
good place to start scraping. You could end up cracking Engine: Check all hoses and wires to make sure everything
more than the ice and end up with a cracked or shattered is in good condition and replace any that need to be. The
windshield/window last thing to do is to make sure the internal components of
the engine remain lubricated and don't corrode.
Pour warm or hot water on the windshield to melt ice. This
will crack your windshield
During Winter Storage: Start the engine occasionally, here If the engine is being started after a very long period of non-
are a few pointers to keep in mind: use, warm up the engine at an idle speed for 2-3 minutes
• Run it in a well-ventilated area. Carbon monoxide can before driving the vehicle.
build up quickly
• Run for a minimum of 20 minutes to allow the engine to
come up to the normal operating temperature. This will
allow the oil to circulate and will also open up the
thermostat so that your radiator anti-freeze circulates as
well
11.16 Head Lamp Bulb Replacement (if equipped) High Beam bulb cap
12 ANNEXURE
12.1 Emission Control System – Multi Languages Alerts
E F 5 C H
ZIP
A B C C A B
A B C
(and) REGEN
DEF Indicator Lamp DPF Indicator Lamp REGEN Indicator Lamp OBD Check Lamp
(and) REGEN
DPF REGEN
DEF
REGEN
REGEN
REGEN
(and) REGEN
DPF REGEN
DEF
REGEN
REGEN
(and) REGEN
DPF REGEN
E31
DEF
E32/E33
E34
E35
E11
E12/E13
E14
E15
REGEN E21
E22/E23
E24
REGEN
E25
(and) REGEN
DPF REGEN
एरर कोड
E31
DEF E32/E33
E34
E35
E11
२० से ३० िमनट के िलए ६० िकमी /
घंटे र तार से वेिहकल को हायवे पर E12/E13
ाइव करे
या E14
REGEN E15
E21
E22/E23
REGEN
E24
E25
(and) REGEN
DPF REGEN
DEF
REGEN
REGEN
(and) REGEN
DPF REGEN
DEF OBD
REGEN
REGEN
E31 डीईएफ़ लेवल लो, इजं न २४०० िकमी म ये सु होणार नाही २४०० िकमी म ये डीईएफ भरा
E32/E33 डीईएफ़ लेवल लो, इजं न ८०० िकमी /... िकमी म ये सु होणार नाही ८०० िकमी म ये डीईएफ भरा
DEF
डीपीएफ संबंिधत अलट E34 र टाट ची परवानगी नाही, डीईएफ़ भरा डीईएफ लगेच भरा
वािनग लै प काय इिं डके ट
म िसंबोल इंजन परफ़ोम स काम काय होईल E35 र टाट ची परवानगी नाही, डीईएफ़ भरा डीईएफ लगेच भरा
टेटस करे ल
२० ते ३० िमिनट पयत ६० िकमी / E11 चुक चे डीईएफ़ आहे असे समजले / चुक चे डीईएफ़ आहे असे समजले यो य डीईएफ भरा
ऑन डीपीएफ तास पीड ने वेिहकल हायवे वर
चोक जाऊन ाइव करा चुक चे डीईएफ़ आहे, इजं न ८०० िकमी /... िकमी म ये सु होणार नाही / चुक चे
िकंवा E12/E13 यो य डीईएफ भरा
हो यास डीईएफ़ आहे, इजं न ८०० िकमी /... िकमी म ये सु होणार नाही
नॉमल पाक रनजनरे शन करा
सु वात िकंवा
झाली िसफ़ा रश केले या मिहं ा डीलर कड़े
E14 र टाट ची परवानगी नाही, डीईएफ़ चेक करा यो य डीईएफ भरा
REGEN ऑन
वेिहकल घेऊन जा
E15 र टाट ची परवानगी नाही, डीईएफ़ चेक करा यो य डीईएफ भरा
डीपीएफ पाक रनजनरे शन करा
ि लंिकंग िकंवा
जवळ जवळ E21 डीईएफ़ डोिझंग मालफं शन मिहं ा डीलरशी संपक करा
िलंप होम िसफ़ा रश के ले या मिहं ा डीलर कड़े
चोक झाला
REGEN ऑन वेिहकल घेऊन जा डीईएफ़ डोिझंग मालफं शन, इजं न ८०० िकमी म ये सु होणार नाही
E22/E23 मिहं ा डीलरशी संपक करा
डीपीएफ डीईएफ़ डोिझगं मालफं शन, इजं न ... िकमी म ये सु होणार नाही
ि लंिकंग पूणपणे चोक िसफ़ा रश के ले या मिहं ा डीलर कड़े
िलंप होम E24 र टाट ची परवानगी नाही, डोिझंग मालफं शन मिहं ा डीलरशी संपक करा
झाला वेिहकल घेऊन जा
ऑन
E25 र टाट ची परवानगी नाही, डोिझंग मालफं शन मिहं ा डीलरशी संपक करा
20
(and) REGEN
DPF REGEN
E31
DEF
E32/E33
E34
E35
E11
E12/E13
REGEN
E14
E15
E21
REGEN
E22/E23
E24
E25
(and) REGEN
DPF ,d;bNfl;lh; tpsf;F REGEN ,d;bNfl;lh; tpsf;F
E31
DEF ,d;bNfl;lh; tpsf;F OBD nrf; tpsf;F
E32/E33 800 800
E34
E35
E11
E12/E13 800
REGEN E14
E15
(my;yJ) E21
REGEN 800
E22/E23
E24
E25
(and) REGEN
DPF REGEN
E31
OBD E32/E33
DEF
E34
E35
E11
E12/E13
E14
REGEN
E15
E21
REGEN E22/E23
E24
E25
Dual Automatic Temperature Control...................... 9-21 Fastening the Seat Belt............................................. 2-23
Feature Description .................................................. 6-84
Flowing Water............................................................. 6-9
Fog Lamps ................................................................ 8-28
H
E Follow-Me Home (FMH) (if equipped) ...................... 8-31
Follow-Me Home (FMH) with Rain Light Sensor
Hazard Warning Flashers ......................................... 10-1
Hazard Warning Lamp.............................................. 8-29
ECO Score ................................................................. 3-13 (RLS) ........................................................................ 8-30 HDC Malfunction ...................................................... 3-51
Electric Adjustable ORVM (If equipped)...................... 8-5 Forgot & Change Password and Forgot & Head Lamp Bulb Replacement (If equipped) ......... 11-25
Electric Brake Force Distribution (EBD) .................... 6-48 Change Pin.............................................................. 1-14 Head Lamp High Beam............................................. 3-49
Electric Brake Prefill - EBP......................................... 6-54 Front Cup Holder/Rear Cup Holder and Armrest Head Restraint.......................................................... 2-16
Electric Parking Brake (EPB) Alert ............................. 6-46 (if equipped)............................................................ 8-10 HHC malfunction ...................................................... 3-46
Electric Parking Brake Malfunction (EPB) ................. 3-46 Front Fog Lamp ........................................................ 3-47 High Beam Assist Lamp............................................ 3-53
Electric Parking Brake-EPB (if equipped) .................. 6-39 Front Seat ................................................................... 2-2 High Engine Coolant Temperature Warning Lamp ...... 3-
Electronic Stability Program (ESP) ............................ 6-48 Fuel Info.................................................................... 3-12 50
Electronic Temperature Control............................... 9-16 Fuel Level Gauge ........................................................ 3-4 Hill Descent Control (HDC) (if equipped) .................. 6-51
Emergency Close Feature........................................... 9-5 Fuel-BS VI .................................................................. 6-35 Hill Hold Control (HHC) (if equipped) ....................... 6-52
Engine Braking.......................................................... 6-24 Fuel-Lid Opening and Closing................................... 5-26 Horn.......................................................................... 6-13
Engine Compartment .....................................11-8, 11-18 Fuelling during Winter .............................................. 6-36 How to turn ACC ON/OFF ......................................... 7-11
Engine Compartment Fuse Box.............................. 10-10 Functionalities of Tiretronics System ....................... 6-70 Hydraulic Brake Assist (HBA) (If equipped) .............. 6-50
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge.......................... 3-5 Fuses & Relays ........................................................ 10-10 Hydraulic Fade Compensation (HFC) ....................... 6-52
Engine Immobiliser System ...................................... 5-23
Engine Number .......................................................... 1-7
Engine Overheating .................................................. 10-6
Engine Stop/Start Lamp............................................ 3-48
Entry and Exit Conditions ......................................... 6-89
G I
EPB Warning Lamp /Parking Brake Warning Lamp...... 6- Gear Lever ................................................................ 6-13 If PKE/RKE is Lost ...................................................... 5-22
42
Alphabetical Index
If your vehicle is submerged ...................................... 6-8 K N
Ignition Key Interlock system (If equipped).............. 6-21
Ignition Switch .......................................................... 6-12 Key Fob Limitations .................................................. 5-23 N : Neutral position .................................................. 6-19
Immobiliser .............................................................. 3-44 Kick-down Function .................................................. 6-23 Navigation ................................................................ 3-15
Inflating Your Tyres .................................................. 6-60 Knee Airbag (If equipped)......................................... 2-35 Neutral Position........................................................ 6-14
Initializing The Power Skyroof .................................... 9-6
Instantaneous Fuel Economy (IFE) ........................... 3-12
Instrument Cluster Control Switches ......................... 3-7
Instrument Cluster Display....................................... 7-11
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FEATURES ............................. 3-1
L O
Instrument Cluster Tell-Tale ..................................... 4-10 Lane Keep Assist System Limitations ....................... 7-59 OBD Check Lamp...................................................... 3-49
Instrument Cluster Tell-Tale -Assames..................... 12-2 LDW System Warning Lamp ..................................... 3-51 Odometer ................................................................... 3-6
Instrument Cluster Tell-Tale -Bengali ....................... 12-4 Lead Me to Vehicle (LMV) ......................................... 8-32 Off-Road Driving Precautions..................................... 6-7
Instrument Cluster Tell-Tale –Tamil ....................... 12-18 Leather Seats.......................................................... 11-22 OPENING AND CLOSING THE VEHICLE....................... 5-1
Instrument Cluster Tell-Tale- Telugu ...................... 12-20 Life of Tyre ................................................................ 6-62 Operation of RPAS .................................................... 6-80
Instrument Cluster Tell-Tale-Gujarathi..................... 12-6 Limitations of RPAS .................................................. 6-83 Operation of Tiretronics ........................................... 6-66
Instrument Cluster Tell-Tale-Hindi ........................... 12-8 Limp Home Mode..................................................... 10-9 ORVM Folding/Unfolding............................................ 8-5
Instrument Cluster Tell-Tale-Kannada ................... 12-10 Limp Home Mode (LHM) .......................................... 6-24 Outside Ambient Temperature .................................. 3-5
Instrument Cluster Tell-Tale-Malayalam ................ 12-12 LKA System Warning Lamp ...................................... 3-52 Override Function....................................................... 7-6
Instrument Cluster Tell-Tale-Marathi ..................... 12-14 Login & Registration ................................................. 1-13
Instrument Cluster Tell-Tale-Oriya ......................... 12-16 Low Engine Oil Pressure Warning Lamp .................. 3-50
Instrument Panel Fuse Box Opening Procedure........ 10- Low Fuel Warning Lamp ........................................... 3-47
15
Instrument Panel Overview...................................... 1-10
Luggage Board............................................................ 8-6 P
Instrument Panel/Interior Trim .............................. 11-22 P : Park Position........................................................ 6-18
Intelli Command Center Switch (ICC) ....................... 8-18 Paint Chips.............................................................. 11-19
Interior Lamps .......................................................... 8-21
Interior Maintenance.............................................. 11-20
M Park Lamp................................................................. 3-46
Parking Brake – Manual (if equipped) ...................... 6-38
Interior Rear-view Mirror (IRVM) ................................ 8-4 M : Manual Shift........................................................ 6-20 Parking Brake Lamp ................................................. 3-45
Maintenance - Inside the Vehicle ........................... 11-15 Parking on a Hill/Incline............................................ 6-38
Maintenance - Outside the Vehicle ........................ 11-15 Passenger Airbag Activation/Deactivation ............... 2-38
Maintenance Guidelines for Camera and Radar Passenger Occupant Detection System (PODS)
J Sensor ....................................................................... 7-8
Manual ORVM (if equipped) ....................................... 8-4
& Seat Belt Reminder Indication (If equipped) ....... 2-25
Pay Attention ............................................................ 6-81
Jacking..................................................................... 10-24 Manual Transmission ............................................... 6-13 Pinch Protection For The Power Skyroof.................... 9-5
Jump Starting............................................................ 10-7 Microphone .............................................................. 8-12 Plastic (Non-painted) Exterior Parts ....................... 11-19
Minimum Fuel Requirement .................................... 6-36 Points to Remember................................................. 9-33
Mirrors........................................................................ 8-4 Power & Torque........................................................ 3-14
Mute/Unmute Function.............................................. 5-9 Power Outlet............................................................. 8-15
Alphabetical Index
Power Window Lock Switch........................................ 8-2 S Steering Controls - Audio ........................................... 7-2
Steering Lock Alerts .................................................. 5-20
Safety Symbols ........................................................... 1-1 Stopping the Engine ................................................... 6-4
Safety Tips - Before Starting Your Vehicle .................. 6-1 Storage Compartments .............................................. 8-6
Q Search Function.......................................................... 5-9
Seat Back/Magazine Pocket...................................... 8-11
Sun Glass Holder ........................................................ 8-7
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) ...................... 2-34
Quick Guide Front Overview ...................................... 1-8 Seat Belt.................................................................... 2-17 SVS Troubleshooting ................................................ 9-47
Seat Belt Configuration ............................................ 2-21 System Limitations ...........................................6-90, 9-47
Seat Belt Height Adjuster ......................................... 2-26
Seat Belt Pretensioner.............................................. 2-21
Seat Belt Release ...................................................... 2-24
R Seat Belt Warning Lamp ........................................... 3-48
T
R : Reverse position .................................................. 6-19 Second Collision Mitigation System (SCM) ............... 6-54
Radial Ply Tyres......................................................... 6-61 Second Row Seats .................................................... 2-11 Tachometer ................................................................ 3-3
Rapid Cabin Cooling ................................................. 9-31 Selective Catalytic Reduction(SCR) ............................. 4-2 Technical Specifications ........................................... 11-2
Rapid Cabin Heating ................................................. 9-32 Self Learning The Power Skyroof ............................... 9-7 Temporary Spare Wheel........................................... 6-64
Rear AC Control ........................................................ 9-31 Servicing and Summary Data ..................................... 1-1 TFT Instrument Cluster screen flow ........................... 3-8
Rear Overview ............................................................ 1-9 SET - Button ................................................................ 7-6 Theft Alarm............................................................... 5-10
Rear Wash................................................................. 8-35 SET+ Button ................................................................ 7-5 Third Row Seats (If equipped) .................................. 2-16
Rear Wiper-INT Mode ............................................... 8-35 Side Curtain Airbag (If equipped) ............................. 2-37 Tilt Steering................................................................. 7-2
Rear Wiper-ON Mode ............................................... 8-35 Side Impact Airbag (If equipped) .............................. 2-36 Tips for Better Fuel Economy ................................... 6-10
Recommended Gear Shifting Speeds ...................... 6-15 Skyroof Close.............................................................. 9-3 Tiretronics................................................................. 3-48
REGEN....................................................................... 3-11 Skyroof Control by Authorised Mobile Phone Tiretronics (if equipped) ........................................... 6-66
Regen Indicator Lamp .............................................. 3-51 Application ................................................................ 9-4 Tiretronics Manual Learning .................................... 6-74
Releasing EPB ........................................................... 6-40 Skyroof Open.............................................................. 9-2 Tiretronics Sensor Installation ................................. 6-67
Remote Engine Start................................................. 8-32 Skyroof Service Checking Procedure.......................... 9-9 Tiretronics Sensor Removal ..................................... 6-68
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System ........................... 5-7 skyroof Tilt Open/Close Position ................................ 9-4 Tiretronics Warning Lamp ........................................ 6-67
RESUME Button .......................................................... 7-6 Smart operations in Ignition OFF State .................... 9-10 To Lock and Arm the Vehicle with RKE ....................... 5-7
Reverse ..................................................................... 6-16 Smart operations in Ignition ON State ..................... 9-12 To Users of a Mahindra Vehicle.................................. 1-2
RKE Operating Range ............................................... 5-10 Smart Pilot Assist System ......................................... 7-60 Tool Kit.................................................................... 10-21
Roll Over Mitigation (ROM)....................................... 6-53 Smart Pilot Assist System Limitations ...................... 7-64 Towing ...................................................................... 10-1
Rollo Shade Close ....................................................... 9-2 Smart Pilot Assist Warning Lamp ............................. 3-54 Towing Equipment ................................................... 10-2
Rollo Shade Open ....................................................... 9-2 Smart Power Window with Anti-Pinch ....................... 8-2 Tread Wear Indicators (TWI) ..................................... 6-61
Roof Overview .......................................................... 1-11 Snow Chains ............................................................. 6-62 Trip Meter ................................................................... 3-9
RPAS Information on Instrument Cluster................. 6-80 Spare Wheel Removal ............................................ 10-21 Turn Lamps............................................................... 3-44
Speedometer.............................................................. 3-3 Tyre Direction Monitoring System (TDMS) ............... 3-31
Starting and Driving Off............................................ 6-22 Tyre Pressure....................................................3-14, 6-59
Starting the Engine ..................................................... 6-2 Tyre Rotation Recommendations............................. 6-63
Steering ...................................................................... 7-1
Alphabetical Index
U
Underbody.............................................................. 11-23
Unlock and Disarm the Vehicle with RKE ................... 5-8
Uphill and Downhill Driving...................................... 6-17
V
Vanity Mirror and Lamp (if equipped) ...................... 8-13
Vehicle Does Not Start - Checks ............................... 10-5
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) ........................... 1-7
Vehicle Info ............................................................... 3-14
W
Warning / Tell-tale Lamps in the Instrument
Cluster..................................................................... 3-33
Warning Triangle .................................................... 10-20
Washing the Exterior .............................................. 11-18
Water-in-Fuel Warning Lamp ................................... 3-44
Wheel Bolt Loosening............................................. 10-23
Wheel Tightness ....................................................... 6-65
Wind Buffeting............................................................ 9-8
Windows and Wiper Blades.................................... 11-20
Windshield Washer Fluid Top-up ........................... 11-14
Windshield Washer Jet - Front & Rear ...................... 8-36
Windshield Wipers.................................................... 8-33
Winter Care............................................................. 11-23
Wipe/Wash ............................................................... 8-33
Wiper Blades........................................................... 11-17
Wiper Control Stalk................................................... 8-33
Wireless Mobile Charging (If equipped) ................... 8-17
Warranty
&
Service Information Guide
Standard Warranty........................................................................... 16
Welcome To Your New XUV700
Dear Customer,
@mahindraxuv700 www.auto.mahindra.com
Thank you for choosing Mahindra XUV700.
@mahindraxuv700
This book describes the various Warranties and After-sales
support services available for your XUV700. @mahindraxuv700 auto.mahindra.com/suv/xuv700
To further demonstrate our commitment to our customer's satisfaction, occasionally we may establish a special policy adjustment to pay for specific repairs that may
not be covered under the standard warranty policy. When we establish such a policy adjustment , we mail details and/or contact over telephone to all applicable owner's
we have on record. We request your cooperation in bringing the vehicle to the nearest Mahindra Authorised Dealer for carrying out these operations, free of cost.
Note - Refer Connected Car Subscription page no.6 for ownership transfer
Name Contact
My Experience Executive
(Sales Consultant)
Name Contact
My Relationship Manager
(Service Advisor)
Name Contact
My Service Manager
Subscription for the connected car is free for a specified 1. Transfer of ownership – When you sell or transfer the
vehicle to another person.
period, depending on the model variant. Post expiry of the free
subscription, the same can be renewed by the user for an
2.“Total Loss” after an accident – When your insurance
company classifies the vehicle as “total loss” and scraps the
extended period. vehicle.
The user’s mobile number provided during KYC will be linked to Contact the Service dept of your Mahindra Authorised Dealer for
the cars SIM and all information will be exchanged between the SIM deactivation.
car and the registered mobile number.
A fresh key can be ordered with the dealer. The key tag no which 3. Keep the duplicate key in a safe and easy to retrieve location
comes along with the key set is required for ordering spare keys. outside the vehicle.
4. Fresh keys , if ordered with the dealer, will be dispatched within
On receipt of the spare key, the dealer will activate and assign the
a few weeks depending on the manufacturing facility of the key
key to your vehicle, for which the vehicle need to be brought to the
workshop supplier.
XX
XX
xxxx
Key Tag Number
Maximum of 2 keys only can be assigned to a vehicle at any time.
M4U application/website:
Roadside Assistance is free for initial 3 years along with Standard vehicle Warranty.
Post expiry of free RSA the same can be renewed at – Mahindra For You mobile app or
Mahindra For You website or at any Mahindra Dealership
For details on RSA Coverage, please refer to Terms & Conditions
Online Approvals : You can view and approve your repair order
online containing details of your service requests, parts and labour WhatsApp Updates :
jobs with related costs. Revisions made to the repair order are also You can subscribe to updates
shared for approval online. on WhatsApp by sending a
"Hi" to the official account of
M4U at 7208071495 . By
Digital Payment : M4U offers you a wide range of online payment
opting-in to this service, you
options across credit & debit cards, net banking, UPI, digital wallets
will receive real-time service
etc. You can view your pre-invoice online and seamlessly proceed
updates on WhatsApp.
for digital payment through the app. Final invoice is shared via e-mail
and also available on the app.
Service booking
This is to certify that the below mentioned vehicle is under WARRANTY coverage. This contract is valid for a period of
3 Years without mileage restriction from the date of retail sale.
Variant
Vehicle Colour
Engine No.
I have read, understood and agree to the terms & conditions
Registration No. of the Warranty Policy as detailed in this document.
* - if equipped
Mahindra SHIELD is an optional extended warranty program You can purchase SHIELD extended warranty at Mahindra For
which extends warranty coverage of your XUV700, at a nominal You Website/mobile app or contact your Relationship Manager/
cost. Service Advisor (or) Experience Executive/ Sales Consultant who
will be more than happy to help you.
Shield program is specially designed to give you extended coverage,
numerous benefits, higher resale value and complete peace of
mind. It is also transferable in case of resale of the vehicle. Its
coverage is provided across any Mahindra XUV700 authorised
workshops in India.
The warranty on tyres are covered under the respective • Improper inflation or other maintenance abuses.
manufacturer's warranty policy. In case of complaints, Mahindra • Continued operation with flat or severely under inflated tyre.
Authorised Dealer will take up the matter with the respective • Mechanical irregularities in the vehicle, such as misalignment,
manufacturer or their authorised agents, on which the final worn or faulty components, and bent wheel assemblies
decision will be theirs and binding to all. resulting in excessive and irregular tread wear
• Use of after-market tyre additives, such as fillers, sealants
or balancing substances, where the added materials are the
cause of a failure.
• Use of incompatible or improper valves, rims or wheels
• Tyres with irregular tread wear.
• Any other terms & conditions as per the individual tyre
Replacement tyres are available at the Mahindra Authorised Dealers. Please
contact the Relationship Manager/Service Advisor when the vehicle is due
manufacturer’s policy
for tyre replacement
Battery Type
Engine No.
Registration No.
DEALER
STAMP &
Date of Sale SIGN
VIN/Chassis No.
All consumables used while carrying out these labor-free services maintenance services , either free or paid , at our authorised
are chargeable. Vehicle wash is offerd as complimentry service Service Centres. These services need to be carried out at the
during the free services. specified kms using recommended fluids and lubricants.
It is important to properly use and maintain the vehicle as • The nature of various jobs carried out by Dealers/ Service
outlined in the maintenance schedule section of this booklet. Centres during services are clearly indicated in the
Regular inspection and maintenance by skilled MAHINDRA maintenance schedule section.
trained technicians is the key to a more efficient operation of your
XUV700. This inspection and maintenance must be carried out
in accordance with the recommendations given in this booklet,
using Genuine parts and lubricants. Ensure that the maintenance
services are recorded in the relevant pages of this booklet.
Diesel
4 Litres (Automatic) MAHINDRA "MAXIMILE ULTRA COOL 2X"
Engine Coolant Genuine Long Life Coolant (Ready to Use Coolant. No Need to Mix Water)
3.75 Litres (Manual) Change as per the km or 3 years whichever is earlier
First change at 70000 kms, Petrol Brand specific. Don't use other Coolants / Water for top up. In case of emergency, Coolant meeting JIS K2234
Specification should be used (40% Concentration Diluted with Distilled water) and coolant change period has to be
then every 100000 kms 4.5 Litres (Automatic) reduced as 30,000 KM
4.25 Litres (Manual)
"MAHINDRA "MAXIMILE SYNTEC F2"
Transmission Oil New Generation Genuine Transmission Fluid"
(Manual Gearbox) Change as per the km (or) 3 years whichever is earlier
1.75 Litres
In case of genuine oil non-availability, manual transmission oil meeting API GL-4 SAE 80W-90 specification
First change at 90000 kms,
is suggested. This alternate oil or other brand may not provide equivalent performance of recommended
then every 100000 kms
genuine oil. Drain Interval should be reduced as 20,000 km.
ATF NWS9638
Transmission Oil Filled for life
7 Litres
(Automatic Gearbox)
Brand specific and no other brands recommended
Brake & Clutch 1.5 Litres Replace as per the km or 2 years whichever earlier, with recommended brands
If Maximile DOT 4 brake fluid is not available and in emergency conditions, use Brake Fluid Meeting SAE
J1703 FMVSS NO.116 DOT 4 OR IS 8654 TYPE-2 Specification. Change it at 30,000 km or 2 years
whichever is earlier
"maxiCLEAN
20 Litres(Capacity) Genuine Diesel Exhaust Fluid"
Diesel Exhaust
Fluid If vehicle covers less than 10000 Km in 2 years, then replace DEF in 2nd year end
Available container
(Only for Diesel)
10, 6 and 2 Litres In case of genuine Diesel Exhaust Fluid (DEF) non-availability, DEF confirming to IS 17042 or ISO 22241
specification only can be used.
Approved car accessories are available at Mahindra Authorised Dealers. GENUINE ACCESSORIES
Please contact the Relationship Manager/Service Advisor for details.
Service Dealer Code Serviced on (Date) Service Dealer Code Coupon No.
1,000 kms.
Serviced at (kms) RO No.
Model
PDI
DEALER
STAMP
DEALER
Registration No.
FREE*
STAMP
20,000 kms.
Serviced at (kms) RO No. Serviced at (kms) RO No.
Engine No.
* Labour free
(all oils & consumables are chargeable)
DEALER DEALER
STAMP STAMP
FREE*
FREE*
Change engine oil as per the km or 1 year whichever is earlier Change engine oil as per the km or 1 year whichever is earlier
PAID SERVICE COUPON
Serviced on (Date) Service Dealer Code Serviced on (Date) Service Dealer Code Coupon No.
30,000 kms.
40,000 kms.
Serviced at (kms) RO No. Serviced at (kms) RO No.
Model
DEALER DEALER
STAMP STAMP Registration No.
PAID
PAID
Change engine oil as per the km or 1 year whichever is earlier Change engine oil as per the km or 1 year whichever is earlier
Vehicle Serial No.
Serviced on (Date) Service Dealer Code Serviced on (Date) Service Dealer Code
50,000 kms.
60,000 kms.
Serviced at (kms) RO No. Serviced at (kms) RO No.
Engine No.
To be serviced at Mahindra
Authorised Dealer only
DEALER DEALER
PAID
STAMP
PAID
STAMP
Change engine oil as per the km or 1 year whichever is earlier Change engine oil as per the km or 1 year whichever is earlier
PAID SERVICE COUPON
Serviced on (Date) Service Dealer Code Serviced on (Date) Service Dealer Code Coupon No.
70,000 kms.
80,000 kms.
Serviced at (kms) RO No. Serviced at (kms) RO No.
Model
DEALER DEALER
STAMP STAMP Registration No.
PAID
PAID
Change engine oil as per the km or 1 year whichever is earlier Change engine oil as per the km or 1 year whichever is earlier
Vehicle Serial No.
100,000 kms.
Serviced on (Date) Service Dealer Code Serviced on (Date) Service Dealer Code
90,000 kms.
To be serviced at Mahindra
Authorised Dealer only
DEALER DEALER
PAID
STAMP STAMP
PAID
Change engine oil as per the km or 1 year whichever is earlier Change engine oil as per the km or 1 year whichever is earlier
Notes on Maintenance
MAHINDRA & MAHINDRA LTD. GATEWAY BUILDING, APOLLO BUNDER, MUMBAI - 400 039 www.mahindra.com
Table of Contents
1 Safety Precautions • This system has a Capacitive type touch panel. Select the
desired option in the screen using his / her finger. Do not
Before using this device, take some time to read through use any sharp objects on the touch screen. On selection
this Instructions Manual. the selected item is highlighted as an acknowledgement.
Knowledge of the operation procedures will help in getting
the best performance out of your new Infotainment System. 1.1 Cleaning of the Unit
Figures from the display and panel presented in this manual
are examples provided for best explaining how the If the front panel of this unit is dirty, clean it with a dry cloth
commands are used. Thus, display figures presented may or slightly soaked in water. If the front panel is too dirty,
be different from those actually presented on the device clean it with a cloth moistened with neutral soap and then
display. Illustrations, technical information, specifications repeat the prior operation.
and descriptions of this brochure were correct until the date
of printing. We safeguard the right to make any required Do not use any cleansing spray with this unit, as that can
amendments according to the ongoing development and affect its mechanical parts. If you clean the front panel with
improvement. a rough cloth that may scratch the surface.
1.2.1 Touch Screen Display ICC is combination of Joystick & switches for easy
ergonomic access for the driver & co driver.
The Infotainment system is equipped with a 10.25” touch
screen TFT display. It has 4 shortcut keys + a central rotary knob.
It displays information about Media (AM/FM, USB, Bluetooth The ICC rotary knob can be selected for volume or for
music & etc.,), Navigation, Vehicle controls & settings browsing (by enabling the corresponding options in
settings).There are options with long press(for Infotainment
user Off) & short press(for select command or Infotainment
user ON)
1.2.3 Steering Wheel Control (SWC) 1. Mute switch is for muting the audio playing in
Infotainment
Infotainment system can be controlled by Steering wheel
switch mounted on the left side of the steering wheel. 2. Volume control can be done with the help of this
switch to increase the volume, move the switch
upwards and to decrease it move the switch
downwards.
A E
3. Call connect is used to accept the incoming call & also
B + it enable the driver to open the contacts list in
VOL
F
-
SEEK Infotainment & make the call.
C G
4. Source switch is used change the source of audio
D
H playing in the Infotainment whether USB or FM.
5. Toggle up/down switch can be used for toggling up/
down the menu list of Infotainment.
A: Mute E: Source 6. Call Disconnect switch is used when the call is over,
and the user wants to cut it then switch can be
B: Volume + F: SEEK UP pressed.
This provide the flexibility of controlling the infotainment
C: Volume - G: SEEK DOWN
system while driving, without any distraction
D: Call Connect H: Voice / Call Disconnect
Fun in XUV 700 shows all the media, phone, navigation, 3rd party application options.
Home Screen Details
Home Screen is the main screen for the user to interact with
the Infotainment System
• Home Screen is displayed when user press the Home icon
or Home button • Features which are available in infotainment screen is
known as Tile.
• This screen also allows the user to have split screen
menus. • For e. g., Radio, Android Auto, Music, Phone, Navigation,
Application and Apple car Play can be accessed through
• The tiles in the Fun in XUV700 screen can be rearranged Home screen tile
based on the user preference
2.1.1 Radio
The Radio tile allows quick access to radio features and the
Radio menu.
• Touching the radio tile will open the full Radio screen, from the tile radio can be played and you can move between the
radio channels.
• When Radio is playing, station name & frequency will be shown in Radio Tile
• Search the station name using seek up/down button on Steering Wheel and enter intended frequency by pressing Seek
button.
A: Mute E: Source
B: Volume + F: UP
C: Volume — G: DOWN
D: Call Connect G: Voice/Call Disconnect
• Android Auto brings out the best of in-car infotainment technology by linking the user’s Android™ device with the Mahindra
infotainment system.
• Android Auto focuses on safety & minimizes user distraction by projecting select Android phone functionality on to the vehicle
infotainment system.
• It allows the user to access and control select applications of Android phone, using various inputs on the vehicle such as touch,
steering wheel controls and voice.
• This makes it safer and easier to interact with the phone while driving.
• To experience Android Auto, the user has to download and install Android Auto app from Google Play Store.
• Android auto is supported at bottom bezel USB port. Also, Android Auto can be connected wirelessly without using USB cable.
Connection:
Features:
User can be able to find in-build apps in infotainment screen
By using the apps, user can make call to their contacts by using phone books.
Navigation system can be accessed to find the desired location.
Music can be played by using in build mobile app
Using Mahindra icon, user can able to switch from Android Auto to vehicle Home screen
2. Phone book
3. Navigation
2.1.3 Music
2.1.4 Phone
Contact Details:
Dial:
SMS:
Quick Dial:
Shortcut icons in the tile is used to access First icon will take the user to Recent Phone
Third icon will take the user to contact details of the connected mobile through infotainment
2.1.5 NAVIGATION
The navigation tile allows the user to open the in-built Map My India maps for navigation.
If any route is currently set up for navigation, it will show the turn-by-turn route.
Navigation works only if the user subscribes to the configured e-SIM at regular intervals
When the navigation screen is displayed on the infotainment, gently touch the infotainment screen once to see the
destination, settings and report on incident option.
Destination:
1. User can set the desired target by selecting the Destination option
2. User can enter the desired destination in the search bar 3. Then route map will be available in screen
Settings:
User can select the settings option & use the below listed
option in settings
1. Live Traffic
2. Avoid on Route
3. Trip Type
4. Driver Assist
5. Map Display
6. Voice
7. Language
8. Map Data
9. Reset
10. About
Report an incident:
If user encounter any of the above incidents, then he/she can report the incident by using Report a Traffic Problem option
These reports help other users to show real-time traffic conditions.
GPS:
GPS navigation system provides voice guidance to the user on how to reach a given destination.
3. While enabling the Navigation icon, infotainment will take user directly to Destination screen
2.1.7 Application
• The Applications tile allows the user to open all available 3rd party applications.
• Touching the Applications tile will open the app drawer.
• It has quick options to open News, Music & food apps.
• By pressing Application tile, App Drawer screen will open automatically
Travel Explorer:
1. Thrillophilia App will open by pressing the Travel Explorer 2. Users can find near by Hotels, famous locations etc., that
icon can be explored by using Thrillophilia
Zomato:
1. Zomato App will open by pressing the food icon 2. User can find near by restaurants by using the above app
• Apple Car Play brings out the best of in-car infotainment technology by linking the user’s iPhone™ device with the Mahindra
infotainment system.
• Apple Car Play focuses on safety & minimizes user distraction by projecting select iPhone functionality on to the vehicle
infotainment system.
• It allows the user to access, and control select applications of iPhone, using various inputs on the vehicle such as touch,
steering wheel controls and voice.
• Examples of some applications of the Apple device that can be controlled include Music, Navigation, Phone call and Google
search
• It enhances the XUV700 driving experience & enables the user to stay focused on the road with simple, intuitive interfaces,
integrated steering wheel controls and a powerful speech recognition.
• This makes it safer and easier to interact with the phone while driving.
Connection:
Enable Bluetooth in your mobile
Pair the mobile Bluetooth with XUV700, then Apple Car Play will connect automatically
Press Apple Car Play to enable the Car Play
Features:
User can find some in-build apps in Apple Car Play. Using the
apps, user can :
- make call to their contacts by using phone books
- access Navigation system to find the desired location
- play Music by using in-build mobile app
- use Siri voice assistance (Apple phone user)
Using Mahindra option, user can switch from Apple Car Play to vehicle Home screen.
Shortcut icon is enabled only when Apple car play is connected to infotainment system
Phone icon in Apple Car Play tile can be used to access the Phone book.
Navigation icon in Apple Car Play tile can be used to access the Navigation.
2.2 Widget
• The widgets display will be fixed in the left corner of the Fun in XUV700 screen.
• The following information will be available as part of widgets
1. Clock
2. Health
3. Gallery
4. Weather
5. NEWS
6. Travel Explorer
7. Calendar
2.2.1 Clock
2.2.2 Health
• Scroll down the Radio and find the Health screen in Widget
• User can connect the mobile or smart watch with vehicle via Bluetooth
• Whenever the device is in the Bluetooth range, then user can be able to see all the listed features
2.2.3 Gallery
• Scroll down the Health screen and find the gallery screen in Widget
• User can be able to see the photos/videos in gallery by press the gallery option
2.2.4 Weather
• Scroll down the gallery screen and find the Weather screen in Widget
• Users can view weather information by selecting the weather icon on the widget
2.2.5 News
• Scroll down the Weather screen and find the NEWS screen in Widget
• User can know the day-to-day news using India Today app by selecting the NEWS app in widget
• Scroll down the Weather screen and find the Travel explorer screen in Widget
• User can search nearby hotels, locations etc., can be accessed by selecting the Travel Advisor app
2.2.7 Calender
• Scroll down the Travel Explorer screen and find the Calendar screen in Widget
• User can fix the Events, Journey Planner, Checklist, Schedule Destination & Pickup Remainder by using calendar
User can set the Radio, Media, Phones, and other screens by
long pressing the intended tile in Split screen.
User can set any four contents in split screen to access the
features easily
Touch Fun with XUV700 screen & user can find the different
drive mode option
After selecting the Zip mode, swipe right side of the screen
Above details are updated according to the last driving pattern. User can reset the Trip details.
By swiping the screen to the right side then user can be able
to see the lap timer option.
Lap timer measures within how many minutes the user can
reach the maximum speed (very useful in racing track and
testing track)
Swipe the screen left side for two times and again go back to drive mode screen
After selecting the Zap mode swipe the right side of the
screen
Swipe the screen left side for two times and again go back to drive mode screen
Swipe the screen left side for two times and again go back to drive mode screen
By using the below option user can configure Engine Power, Brake, Climate, Steering Behavior, and Theme by selecting
different drive modes (Zip, Zap or Zoom mode)
Swipe the screen left side for two times and again go back to
drive mode screen
The Quick Access Drawer can be opened by dragging the screen from up to down.
Quick Access Drawer gives the user a swift way to access handy features like Volume control, Ask Mahindra (if equipped),
Roadside Assistance, Valet Mode, Notifications, Help, Radio, Apple Car Play, Android Auto, My Drive, USB, Bluetooth, iPod, and
video.
CAUTION:
Some Infotainment features may not work when the Ask Mahindra call is in progress
2.8.3 RSA
Allows the user to park the vehicle in a predefined location while giving the vehicle to valet parking. The default PIN to access
the Valet mode will be 1234.
Once the Valet Mode is enabled,
• Infotainment screen will not be accessible,
• The vehicle speed will not go beyond 80 Kmph,
• Geofencing alert will be triggered to the user's mobile when an unknown person drives the vehicle over 5 Km.
• Above conditions are not applicable, if user disables the valet mode.
• Don’t activate the valet mode during vehicle service
2.8.5 Notification
2.8.6 Help
• Using Help option user can know the unknown alerts and telltale details in Owners Manual or Infotainment Manual
2.8.7 Radio
By selecting the equalizer icon, Audio settings will be opened. User can adjust the Bass, Mid, Treble & Sub woofer.
By selecting the Browse folder user can see the Favorites, Genres, Artist, Album, Songs, Composers
2.8.11 USB
By selecting the equalizer icon, Audio settings will be opened. User can adjust the Bass, Mid, Treble & Subwoofer.
By selecting the Browse folder, Browse MyDrive screen will opened. User can see the Favorites, Genres, Artist, Album, Songs &
Composers.
2.8.12 Bluetooth
By selecting the equalizer icon, Audio settings will be opened. User can adjust the Bass, Mid, Treble & Subwoofer.
2.8.13 iPod
If user have iPhone, then car play application can be disabled through iPhone settings. To play the music, connect the USB
cable to media port and play songs through mobile APP.
By selecting the equalizer icon, Audio settings will be opened. User can adjust the Bass, Mid, Treble & Subwoofer.
By selecting the Browse folder user can see the Favorites, Genres, Artist, Album, Songs, Composers
2.8.14 Video
• When USB device is connected in Media Port, then user can play Videos.
• In App drawer, select Gallery option & select the video in gallery. Video will play automatically
The App Drawer allows user to browse through available apps and folders and launch selected one.
Based on the usage of Apps, reordering will be done automatically
• User can select add folder and can drag the existing apps available in app drawer to New Folder
• User can rename the folder as per his/her choice.
• User can press Climate Control option and select different modes available in XUV700.
• Types of modes are described below
Face Mode:
User can select Face & Foot mode to get airflow from both
instrument panel air vents and footwell air vents
Foot Mode:
User can select Foot mode to get airflow from footwell air
vents
User can select Foot & Defogger mode to get airflow from
footwell air vents & Defogger vents
Defogger vent is used to clear the frost/mist, which is
formed on Front windshield.
Recirculation Mode:
Auto Mode:
Smart Air Filter is used to convert the polluted air into non
polluted air
Power Off:
HVAC system is turned off when the user presses the power
button.
Press the power button to restart the HVAC system
Manufacturer Update
In Over the Air Surprise, Mahindra will provide regular update to the user regarding following details:
Happy Birthday wishes to the user - Owner birth date is shown in this feature
ADVISORY - User can know whether Android Auto is available in his/her vehicle
Advisory
XUV700 is loaded with lot of new features, user can explore the New Features as per his/her requirements.
There is possibility that long and repeated features can be explored in Engine OFF condition.
But, if ignition is in ON condition and vehicle is idle for days/hours, then there is chance of battery drainage.
To avoid this Mahindra had asked the user to switch ON the Engine
RESTORE - Once the update is done, all the details in AdrenoX Connect service have been restored.
HAPPY DIWALI - Pushed message for the Seasons Greetings can be viewed.
HAPPY DUSSEHRA - Pushed message for the Seasons Greetings can be viewed.
Happy Birthday wishes to the user - Pushed message for Birthday Wishes can be viewed.
Personalized Safety alert will pop-up when user drives the vehicle in over speed condition.
As a remembrance, user can customize alert voice of his / her loved ones.
When user drive the vehicle rashly voice will come & alert the user
1. Settings: User can able to save the voice and can able to
enable or disable the option
Calender
User can fix the Events, Journey Planner, Checklist, Schedule Destination & Pickup Reminder by using calendar
2.9.4 Documents
User can store the important files like License, Aadhar card, Pan card, Voter I’d , etc., in pdf format
In Download Manager, user can know the applications which are available on Infotainment Systems.
User can select the required APP and view various details available in it.
News - By using NEWS app user can listen the daily NEWS
In Drive mode user can be able to access four different drive modes.
1. Zip mode
2. Zap mode
3. Zoom mode
4. Custom mode
Zip mode
ZAP MODE:
After activating the Zap mode, the user can experience the
TRUE Mahindra SUV drive experience.
ZOOM MODE:
CUSTOM MODE:
In Custom mode, user can configure Zip/Zap/Zoom mode functionalities for the 5-parameters i. e. Engine Power, Brakes,
Climate, Steering and Theme
2.9.8 Gallery
User can save photos & videos in the Gallery by inserting USB device in Media Port. Also, user can copy the photos & videos in
MyDrive Photos and MyDrive videos.
Use can select MyDrive Photos, see the list of Photos and
select to see it in full screen.
Similarly, user can play the video in infotainment system.
As a safety measure, there are some limitations to play the
video in infotainment.
2.9.9 Horoscope
By using the Horoscope app user can view daily fortune as per his/her zodiac sign
User can search various services by using the Just Dial app in the infotainment
Insert USB device in Media Port & open the My Drive Manager then user can copy required songs, videos, photos and
documents to the infotainment system
In MySUVInfo option, user can know the Vehicle Details and can store License & other certificates in digital format.
Vehicle Details
My Documents:
By using NEWS app user can easily listen World NEWS, Top News, Automobile News, Business, Sports & etc.,
By using Owner’s Manual option, user can see XUV700 Owner's manual & Infotainment manual
Surround View System / 360-degree Camera View System assists the user during parking and during low speed maneuvering.
Surround View Assistance is provided with the help of 4 cameras located in the front grille, in the tailgate applique and on
both exterior mirrors.
Using this option, user can see different Surrounding views in infotainment system
Different Surrounding views details are listed below:
This view assist the user to drive the vehicle carefully in front
area.
User can see the front surroundings while maneuvering in
front.
This view assists the user with Rear surrounding view for
maneuvering in rear of the vehicle.
This view helps the user to see the left side view near the
front tire when parking
This view helps the user to see the right side view near the
front tire when parking
This view helps the user to see the objects closer to rear
bumper
This view helps the user to see the object closer to front
bumper
The bird’s eye view/2D top view shows the view of the
vehicle from a top-down view (as in right side of image)
stitching all the 4 camera images
3D Views
SVS - Settings
Parking Guidelines
In Parking Guidelines, two modes are available i.e. Static Guideline & Dynamic Guideline.
Static Guideline indicates the placement of vehicle with respect to the parking slot.
Dynamic Guideline indicates the path that the vehicle will traverse with the current steering angle position.
Color codes (Red, Yellow, Green) on the static lines helps in assessing obstacle distance [at the ground plane] from the
vehicle’s boundary.
• By selecting 2D view, user can see either Front View or Rear View. 2D view is the Default view.
• By selecting 3D view, user can see Full View of the vehicle.
Automatic Side View
• When Left / Right Turn Indicator is turned ON and 3D view is active, then view will switch to 3D Left / Right in Infotainment
Screen
• This feature can be Enabled / Disabled from SVS SETTINGS menu
Parking Assistance:
Two types of Parking Assistances are available in XUV700
• Vertical (Perpendicular) Parking Assistance:
1. Choose Vertical Parking icon from SVS-Settings. Overlays will appear on either side as in image below.
2. Drive ahead of the parking slot, so that camera can have the parking slot view.
3. Chose vertical parking button from settings. Overlays will appear on either side.
Ticker Tape feature helps users to track the stock prices and other financial data by providing real-time information on various
stock trades and other relevant financial data.
Travel Explorer takes the user thrillophilia app and it helps the user to find near by hotels, famous location etc.,
It is a personalized profile and user can choose this option to control climate setting, preferred audio source, audio settings,
application drawer, link profile to key fob, Lock my Profile etc.
User Profile
In the given screen user have two Profile and one guest
profile.
User can adapt person specific settings for First, Second and
Guest Profiles.
Name
Climate
Audio Source
User can choose the preferred audio source for the profile.
When preferred audio source is not available, default audio
source will be played.
Audio Settings
Screen Saver
Application Drawer
User can link the profile with the key fob. By using this
setting, once user enter the vehicle with the desired key fob,
then all the saved settings will updated automatically.
Lock My Profile
2.9.19 Accuweather
2.9.20 Zomato
By using Zomato app, user can order food from near by restaurants.
2.10 Settings
Some settings, which are needed frequently are provided up-front as Quick Settings on Infotainment Screen.
Quick Settings
Volume: Using ICC Knob user can rotate the ICC knob in
clockwise or Anti clockwise direction to increase or decrease
the volume
All Setting
2.15 General
Factory Reset
Software Update
If Auto Download option is enabled and any update is
available, then software update will happen automatically.
Brightness
User can increase or decrease the brightness of
Infotainment and Instrument Cluster.
Clock Type
Home Layout
In Home Layout, user can have the screen view as per his
choice.
If another user wants to set the original settings, then the
user can select reset option
.
User can set the Date & Time by using this option.
Sync to GPS:
Time Zone
By using this option user can manually fix the different time
zones
Set Date
User can set and fix the Date format either in DD/MM/YY or
MM/DD/YY format.
Set Time
User can set and fix the Time format either in 12 Hour or 24
Hour.
Using Audio Settings, user can change the sound effects in different positions.
3D Sound
Party Mode
Just like Disco Club, music will come from multi direction
without sound stage (music will come from particular
distance) NO sound image localization (user can feel the
special instruments like guitar, keyboard, etc.,)
User can hear the normal sound just like normal speakers
and Sound Field Size option gets disabled when user select
the 3D OFF option
This setting will provide the ambience of theatre (Large), stage (Mid) or personal music room (Small) by selecting the sound
level.
User cannot access Sound Field Size option when 3D OFF option is in OFF condition.
Volume Settings
Enter the 6-digit code that you receive from the XUV700
infotainment screen
After registering the correct code, your mobile/lap/tab will appear the above screen
Once account is activated, user will see the guide Screen. Press done to complete login activities.
Things to Try
Contact List
Notification
Request Sound
Sign Out
In case if you don’t want to use Alexa, you can sign out any
time in settings
2.20 Phone
By using Phone option, user can enable Bluetooth settings in vehicle, check available devices, add device, pair device using BT,
fix the ringtone and can alter SMS settings.
Bluetooth
Device List
Add Devices
Bluetooth Discoverability
Ring Tone
SMS Settings
Enable Sms Signature:
User can add a text in bottom that this message is send from
my car.
While driving, user can fix a message, I’m in driving or I’ll call
you back.
Sms Readout:
User can find the below option by selecting the Vehicle settings option
Access
Selection Unlock
Service Mode
User can find the below options by using User Input & Feedback
Voice Alerts
2.23 Wifi
By using Wi-fi device option, user can know the name of vehicle Wi-Fi and can change the password of the Wi-fi.
3 Frequently Asked Questions (FAQs) 5. I can’t Accept or decline Whatsapp call from IVI?
IVI will support bluetooth phone voice call and
1. How to connect phone via Bluetooth in Infotainment? supportability of Whatsapp, MS Team call depends on
User can connect Bluetooth using any of the below the controls provided by Mobile device/app to
methods, in Bluetooth settings. Infotainment
Add device: Kindly ensure, Mobile device should be in 6. During active call, I’m getting Navigation Prompts?
bluetooth settings screen to accept the connection
During call, Navigation prompts will still come so user
Bluetooth discoverability: Kindly ensure, Mobile don’t miss any direction. User can adjust the volume
device start scan after discoverability is turned On of navigation prompts as required
2. My contacts are taking time to load in IVI? 7. Next /Previous, fast forward/rewind etc. controls not
working for Bluetooth music?
Based on the Mobile device and number of contacts,
loading time may vary from few seconds to few The availability of the features/control is dependent
minutes on the Bluetooth version of phone device and music
application used in phone.
3. Bluetooth Music is not playing in Infotainment?
8. While playing USB song album art not displaying?
After connecting mobile device to bluetooth, user
need to select his device for media in device list and Album art will display in the screen, only if the song
then select bluetooth music source in Infotainment to has album art information
Play music.
9. While playing songs from USB, few files are getting
4. Few Phone Contacts are not visible in Infotainment skipped?
Screen?
If the Infotainment system comes across a corrupt
Ensure that your phone book contacts do not have music track in media source, the system might skip to
special characters before their name. If there are such next music track in the media source.
contacts, please rename them.
10. Date & Time in my Infotainment is Incorrect?
User can Sync to GPS or manually set Date & time in Step 2: Click and open Alexa icon
settings. After selecting Sync to GPS, need to drive
Step 3: Click on the “Get started” button to get the
vehicle few Kms in open sky to ensure proper date
code
and time based on the time zone selected.
Step 4: Provide sometime to system to fetch code
11. Sources are disabled in QAD? from internet.
Source will be active only when device is connected e. Step 5: Infotainment will display code to activate.
g., for USB, Pendrive should be connected.
Step 6 & 7: Open mobile browser and Go to url : www.
12. Can I reduce the Navigation Volume? amazon.com/code and login to your amazon account
Yes, user can adjust Navigation or other source (If new user please create amazon account). Enter the
volume, in Audio Settings. code seen in the screen in the box provided and click
on continue button.
13. Not able to control Volume using ICC?
User need to select Volume instead of Browse in ICC
rotary Quick settings.
14. Alexa not responding to my query?
Few of the Alexa In car control commands might not
work based on the vehicle variant (AC, Window,
Sunroof & etc.,).
Also Alexa might not hear your query, in case
background music or noise is High.
15. How to connect Alexa?
Step 1: Click on the settings button in Infotainment
Home Screen
15. Next Song -Alexa, Next Song 29. Increase Temperature - Alexa, Increase
Temperature
16. Previous Song -Alexa, Previous Song
30. Decrease Temperature - Alexa, Decrease
17. Tune to FM/AM Station / Favourite -Alexa, tune Temperature
to 93.5
31. Increase Temperature by X degrees - Alexa,
18. Exit navigation/Route -Alexa, Exit navigation Increase Temperature by 5 degrees
19. Open Sunroof -Alexa, Open Sunroof 32. Decrease Temperature by X Degrees - Alexa,
20. Close Sunroof -Alexa, Close Sunroof Decrease Temperature by 5 Degrees
21. Open Windows - (will open only driver seat 33. Set Temperature to specific value - Alexa, Set
window) Temperature to <specific value>
22. Close Windows (will close only driver seat 17. What are all different Online commands categories
window) Alexa Support?
23. AC ON -Alexa, turn ON AC Following are the Online command categories for
Alexa (Works only with internet connection inside the
24. AC OFF -Alexa, Turn OFF AC car)
25. Reduce Fan Speed - Alexa, Reduce Fan Speed 1. Search for location - Alexa, Search for location
<location name>
26. Increase Fan Speed - Alexa, Increase Fan Speed
2. Search for POI - Restaurants - Alexa, search
27. Maximum Fan Speed - Alexa set fan speed nearby restaurants/ coffee shop
maximum
3. Search for POI - Fuel Stations - Alexa, nearby
28. Minimum Fan Speed - Alexa set fan speed Fuel Stations
minimum
4. Search for POI - ATM - Alexa, nearby ATM
5. Search for POI - Rest Area - Alexa, near by rest 18. How to use Mahindra Alexa custom skills for XUV700 ?
area
Prerequisite –
6. Search for POI - Hospital - Alexa, nearby hospital
• User needs to have the Alexa app installed in their
7. Navigate to the location - Alexa, Navigate to the phone.
<location name>
• User needs to have the AdrenoX Connect app
8. General Information Enquiry - Alexa, tell me installed & registered in their phone.
about Chennai/ tell me about Sachin Tendulkar
9. Weather updates - Alexa, how is the weather
today
10. Online content streaming - Alexa, tell me a story
11. Online music from Specific MSP - Alexa, play
music/ Bollywood songs
12. News Updates - Alexa, news update/ today's
news
13. Alexa Home Control - Alexa, turn on hallway
light (make sure account has smart home device
like bulb etc. are synced)
14. Alarm, Timer, Reminders - Alexa, reminder to
pick up dad tomorrow at 10 AM/ Set alarm for 6
AM tomorrow
15. To do list, Shopping list - Alexa, add pen to
shopping list
Step 1: Step 2:
• Log in to the AdrenoX Connect App Click on ‘In-Home Alexa’ under the Settings menu
• Press the hamburger menu on top right corner to
open the menu tray
• Open ‘Settings’
Step 3: Step 4:
• Click on ‘Continue’ • User needs to link their Amazon Account with the
AdrenoX Connect App
• This will redirect to the Amazon Alexa app
• Click on the ‘Link’ button
Step 5: Step 6:
• Once linked, open the AdrenoX Connect app • Account linked successfully will be displayed
through the pop-screen as shown
Step 7:
Step 8: Step 9:
• Go to ‘Your Skills’ section • Click on ‘Settings’.
• Click on ‘Mahindra’ Skill
Step 2:
Click on ‘Settings’ option to access the app settings Step 5:
Step 3: • Under MUSIC, click on ‘Change’ button to change the
default services from Amazon music to user’s preferred
• Under the settings page, click on ‘Music & Podcasts’ choice
under the ALEXA PREFERNECES to change the default
services Step 6:
Step 4: • Select the preferred music services from the list to set as
default for Alexa
• Amazon Music would be preselected as Default Services
• Click on the ‘Default Services’ option
Once the default music services are selected, Alexa will use
this to play music whenever user gives the request as “Alexa,
play music” across the ecosystem including the XUV700’s
In case music streaming services ‘Gaana’, ‘Hungama Music’, infotainment.
‘Spotify’ etc. are not listed under SERVICES user needs to first
link these services to the Amazon Alexa.
A. Link Alexa to Apple Music, Apple Podcast, Spotify or
JioSaavn - Click on the add icon alongside the ‘Link New
Service’ to Link Alexa to these music services
B. Link Alexa to Gaana or Hungama Music – Enable Gaana &
Hungama Music skills from the ‘Skills and Games’ section of
the Alexa app first.
4 Appendix
Abbreviations
Acronym Description
BT Blue tooth
SWC Steering Wheel control
ICC Intelli Command Control
IVI In Vehicle Infotainment